blob: fafaa3470886f878ec82299f6014d29df3943958 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreau437fd282022-12-01 15:16:46 +01006 2022/12/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100759* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
760 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
761 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
762
763 Example:
764 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
765 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
766
767* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
768 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
769
770* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
771 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
774
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500775* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200776 processes, separated by semicolons.
777
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500778* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779 CLI, separated by semicolons.
780
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200781In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
782regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
783only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
784
785* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
786
787* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
788 starting at one.
789
790* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
791 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
792 first section.
793
794These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
795if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
796section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
797"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
798proxies.
799
800This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
801logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
802to name some config objects like servers for example.
803
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200804See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200805
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100806
8072.4. Conditional blocks
808-----------------------
809
810It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
811some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
812ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
813configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
814versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
815preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
816text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
817lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
818switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
819are defined to form conditional blocks:
820
821 - .if <condition>
822 - .elif <condition>
823 - .else
824 - .endif
825
826The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
827as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
828matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
829there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
830only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
831".elif" of a block.
832
833Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
834ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
835as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
836
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200837Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
838See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
839
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200840The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
841expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100843 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
844 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200846 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530847 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
848 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200849 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
850 from left to right until one returns false
851 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
852 from right to left until one returns true
853
854Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
855operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200856
857The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
858
859 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
860 exists, regardless of its contents
861
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
863 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
864 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
867 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
870 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
871 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
872 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
873
874 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
875 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
876 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
877 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
878
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200879Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200881 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
882 listen mwcli_px
883 bind :1111
884 ...
885 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
888 bind :80
889 .endif
890
891 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200892 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200893 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200894 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200895 .endif
896
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200897 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200898 bind :443 ssl crt ...
899 .endif
900
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200901 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
902 profiling.memory on
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200905 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
906 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
907 .endif
908
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200909Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100910
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200911 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
913 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
914 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
915
916Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
917"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
918fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
919provide advice to the user.
920
921Example:
922
923 .if "${A}"
924 .if "${B}"
925 .notice "A=1, B=1"
926 .elif "${C}"
927 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
928 .elif "${D}"
929 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
930 .else
931 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
932 .endif
933 .else
934 .notice "A=0"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
938 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
939
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940
9412.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200942----------------
943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100944Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
946otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
947numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
948for every keyword. Supported units are :
949
950 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
951 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
952 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
953 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
954 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
955 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
956
957
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009582.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200959-------------
960
961 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
962 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
963 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 frontend http-in
975 bind *:80
976 default_backend servers
977
978 backend servers
979 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
980
981
982 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
983 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
984 global
985 daemon
986 maxconn 256
987
988 defaults
989 mode http
990 timeout connect 5000ms
991 timeout client 50000ms
992 timeout server 50000ms
993
994 listen http-in
995 bind *:80
996 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
997
998
999Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1000
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001001 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001002
1003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010043. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005--------------------
1006
1007Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1008are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1009of them have command-line equivalents.
1010
1011The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1012
1013 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001014 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001015 - 51degrees-cache-size
1016 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001017 - 51degrees-difference
1018 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001021 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1022 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001023 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001025 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001029 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - description
1031 - deviceatlas-json-file
1032 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001034 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001035 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001036 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001037 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001039 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001041 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1042 - h1-case-adjust
1043 - h1-case-adjust-file
1044 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001045 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001046 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1047 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1048 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1049 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001050 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001051 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001052 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001053 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001055 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001056 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001057 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001058 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001059 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001060 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001061 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001062 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001063 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001065 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001066 - presetenv
1067 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001068 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001069 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001071 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001073 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - ssl-default-bind-options
1075 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001076 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - ssl-default-server-options
1078 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001079 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001080 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001081 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001082 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001083 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001084 - stats
1085 - strict-limits
1086 - uid
1087 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001088 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001090 - user
1091 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001092 - wurfl-data-file
1093 - wurfl-information-list
1094 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001097 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001098 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - maxcompcpuusage
1100 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001102 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001103 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001104 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001105 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001106 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001108 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001110 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001111 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001112 - nokqueue
1113 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001114 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001116 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001117 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001118 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001119 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001120 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001121 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - tune.buffers.limit
1123 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001124 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001125 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001126 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001127 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001128 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001129 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001130 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001131 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001132 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001133 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001134 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001135 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001136 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001137 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001138 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1139 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001140 - tune.maxaccept
1141 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001142 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001143 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001144 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001145 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001146 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001147 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1148 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001149 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001150 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001151 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001152 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001153 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001154 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1155 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001156 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001157 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001158 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001159 - tune.sndbuf.client
1160 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001161 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001162 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1163 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1164 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001165 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1166 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001167 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001168 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1169 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001170 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001171 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001172 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001173 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1174 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1175 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001176 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1177 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001178
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001180 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001181 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001182 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001183
1184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011853.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001186------------------------------------
1187
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100118851degrees-data-file <file path>
1189 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1190 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1191
1192 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001193 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001194
119551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1196 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1197 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1198 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1199
1200 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001201 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001202
120351degrees-property-separator <char>
1204 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1205 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1206
1207 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001208 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001209
121051degrees-cache-size <number>
1211 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1212 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1213 By default, this cache is disabled.
1214
1215 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001216 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001217
121851degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1219 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1220 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1221
1222 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001223 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001224
122551degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1226 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1227 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1228
1229 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001230 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001231
123251degrees-drift <number>
1233 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1234
1235 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001236 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001237
123851degrees-difference <number>
1239 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1240
1241 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001242 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001243
124451degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1245 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1246 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001249 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001250
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001251ca-base <dir>
1252 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001253 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1254 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1255 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001256
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001257chroot <jail dir>
1258 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1259 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1260 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1261 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1262 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001263 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001264
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001265close-spread-time <time>
1266 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1267 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1268 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1269 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1270 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1271 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1272 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1273 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001274 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1275 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1276 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1277 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1278 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001279
1280 Arguments :
1281 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001282 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1283 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001284
1285 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1286 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1287 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1288
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001289 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001290
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001291cluster-secret <secret>
1292 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1293 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1294 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1295 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001296 tokens.
1297
1298 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1299 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1300 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001301
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001302cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1303 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1304 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1305 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1306 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1307 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001308
1309 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1310
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001311 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001312 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1313 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1314 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1315 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1316 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1317 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1318 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1319 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1320 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1321 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1322 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1323 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1324 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001325
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001326 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1327 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1328 on the machine's word size.
1329
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001330 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1331 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001332 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1333 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001334 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001335 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1336 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001337
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001338 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1339 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1340 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1341 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1342 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001343
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001344 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001345 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001346 # first 4 CPUs
1347
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001348 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1349 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001350 # word size.
1351
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001352 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001353 # and so on.
1354 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1355 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1356 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1357
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001358 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1359 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1360 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1361 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001362
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001363 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1364 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1365 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001366
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001367 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1368 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1369 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1370 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1371 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1372
1373 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1374 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1375 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1376 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1377 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1378 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1379 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1380
1381
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001382crt-base <dir>
1383 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001384 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1385 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001386
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387daemon
1388 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1389 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001390 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1391 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001392
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001393default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001394 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001395 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1396 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1397 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1398 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1399 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1400 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1401 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1402 not start with a slash ('/'):
1403 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1404 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1405
1406 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1407 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1408 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1409 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1410 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1411 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1412 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1413 each of them.
1414
1415 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1416 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1417 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1418 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1419 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1420 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1421 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1422 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1423
1424 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1425 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001426 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001427 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1428 made easily relocatable.
1429
1430 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1431 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1432 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1433 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1434 consistent across all configuration files.
1435
1436 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1437 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1438 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1439 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1440 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1441 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1442 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1443 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1444
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001445description <text>
1446 Add a text that describes the instance.
1447
1448 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1449 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1450 "<" and ">" characters.
1451
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001452deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1453 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001454 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001455
1456deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001457 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001458 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1459
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001460deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001461 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1462 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1463 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001464
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001465deviceatlas-separator <char>
1466 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1467 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1468
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001469expose-experimental-directives
1470 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1471 the config file will be rejected.
1472
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001473external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001474 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1475 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001476 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1477 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1478 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1479 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1480 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001481
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001482fd-hard-limit <number>
1483 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1484 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1485 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1486 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1487 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1488 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1489 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1490 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1491 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1492 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1493 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1494 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1495
1496 global
1497 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1498 fd-hard-limit 50000
1499
1500 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1501
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001502gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001503 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001504 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1505 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001506 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001507 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001508 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001509
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001510grace <time>
1511 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1512
1513 Arguments :
1514 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1515 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1516 soft-stop operation.
1517
1518 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1519 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1520 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1521 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1522 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1523 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1524 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1525 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1526 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1527
1528 Example:
1529
1530 global
1531 grace 10s
1532
1533 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1534 frontend ext-check
1535 bind :9999
1536 monitor-uri /ext-check
1537 monitor fail if { stopping }
1538
1539 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1540 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1541 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1542 SIGUSR1 signal.
1543
1544 Example:
1545
1546 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1547 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1548 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1549 frontend ext-check
1550 bind :9999
1551 monitor-uri /ext-check
1552 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1553
1554 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1555
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001556group <group name>
1557 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1558 See also "gid" and "user".
1559
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001560h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1561 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1562
1563 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1564 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1565 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1566 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1567 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1568 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1569 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1570
1571 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1572 option may be set.
1573
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001574h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1575 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1576 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1577 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1578 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001579 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001580 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1581 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1582 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1583 specified in a proxy.
1584
1585 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1586 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1587 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1588 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1589 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1590 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1591 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1592
1593 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1594 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1595 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1596 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1597 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1598
1599 Example:
1600 global
1601 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1602
1603 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1604 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1605
1606h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1607 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1608 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1609 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1610 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1611 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1612 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1613 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1614 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1615
1616 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1617 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1618 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1619
1620 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1621 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1622
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001623h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1624 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1625 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1626 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1627 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1628 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1629 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1630 the keyword with "no'.
1631
1632hard-stop-after <time>
1633 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1634
1635 Arguments :
1636 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1637 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1638 SIGUSR1 signal.
1639
1640 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1641 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1642 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1643
1644 Example:
1645 global
1646 hard-stop-after 30s
1647
1648 See also: grace
1649
1650httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1651 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1652 to resolve.
1653
1654 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1655 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1656
1657 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1658 configuration error if it fails to load.
1659
1660httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1661 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1662 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1663 option is "ipv6".
1664
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001665httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1666 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1667 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1668 server line.
1669
1670 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1671 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1672 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1673
1674 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1675 configuration error if it fails.
1676
1677httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1678 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1679 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1680
1681 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1682 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1683
1684 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1685 configuration error if it fails.
1686
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001687insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001688 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001689 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1690 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1691 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1692 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1693 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1694 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1695 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001696 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001697 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1698 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1699 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1700 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1701 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1702 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1703 disable it.
1704
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001705insecure-setuid-wanted
1706 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1707 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1708 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1709 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001710 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001711 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001712 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001713 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1714 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001716 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1717 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1718 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1719 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1720
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001721issuers-chain-path <dir>
1722 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1723 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1724 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001725 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001726 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1727 "issuers-chain-path".
1728 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1729 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1730 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1731 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1732 will share the chain in memory.
1733
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001734localpeer <name>
1735 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1736 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1737 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1738 the configuration parsing.
1739
1740 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1741 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1742
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001743log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001744 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001745 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001746 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001747 configured with "log global".
1748
1749 <address> can be one of:
1750
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001751 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001752 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1753 port).
1754
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001755 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1756 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1757 port).
1758
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001759 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001760 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1761 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001763
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001764 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1765 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1766 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1767 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1768 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1769 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1770 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1771 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1772 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1773 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001774 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001775 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1776 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1777 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001778 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1779 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001780
1781 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1782 "fd@2", see above.
1783
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001784 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1785 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1786 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1787 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1788 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1789
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001790 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1791 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001792
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001793 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1794 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1795 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1796 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1797 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1798 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1799 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1800 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1801 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1802 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001803 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1804 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001805
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001806 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1807 one of the following :
1808
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001809 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1810 field is stripped. This is the default.
1811 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1812 rfc3164.
1813
1814 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001815 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1816
1817 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1818 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1819
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001820 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1821 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1822 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1823 designed to be used with a local log server.
1824
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001825 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1826 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1827 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1828 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1829 logger consumes.
1830
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001831 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1832 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1833 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1834 used with a local log server.
1835
1836 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1837 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1838 designed to be used with a local log server.
1839
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001840 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1841 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1842 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1843 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1844
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001845 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1846 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1847 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1848 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1849 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1850
1851 <sample_size>
1852 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1853 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1854 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1855 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1856 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1857
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001858 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001859
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001860 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1861 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1862 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1863
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001864 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1865 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1866 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1867 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001868
1869 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001870 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1871 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1872 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1873 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1874 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1875 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001876
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001877 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001878
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001879log-send-hostname [<string>]
1880 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1881 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1882 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1883 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1884 the logs.
1885
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001886log-tag <string>
1887 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1888 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1889 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001890 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001891
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001892lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001893 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1894 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1895 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1896 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1897 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1898 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001899 used multiple times.
1900
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001901 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001902 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001903 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001904 other files.
1905
1906 local args = table.pack(...)
1907
1908lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001909 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1910 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1911 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1912 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1913 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1914 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1915 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1916 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1917 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1918 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1919 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1920 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1921 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1922 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1923 times.
1924
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001925 See lua-load for usage of args.
1926
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001927lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1928 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1929 variable.
1930 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1931 to "path".
1932
1933 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1934 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1935 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1936 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1937 will be checked earlier.
1938
1939 As an example by specifying the following path:
1940
1941 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1942 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1943
1944 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1945 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1946 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1947 paths if that does not exist either.
1948
1949 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1950 documentation.
1951
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001952master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001953 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1954 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1955 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001956 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001957 or daemon mode.
1958
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001959 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1960 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1961 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1962 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1963 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001964
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001965 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001966
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001967mworker-max-reloads <number>
1968 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001969 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001970 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1971 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1972 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1973
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001974nbthread <number>
1975 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001976 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1977 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1978 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1979 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1980 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1981 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1982 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001983
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001984numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001985 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1986 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1987 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1988 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1989 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1990 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1991 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1992 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1993 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1994 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001995
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001996pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001997 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1998 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1999 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2000 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002001
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002002pp2-never-send-local
2003 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2004 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2005 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2006 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2007 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2008 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2009 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2010 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2011 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2012 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2013 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2014
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002015presetenv <name> <value>
2016 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2017 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2018 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2019 and "unsetenv".
2020
2021resetenv [<name> ...]
2022 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2023 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2024 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2025 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2026 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2027 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2028 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2029 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2030
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002031server-state-base <directory>
2032 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002033 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2034 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002035
2036server-state-file <file>
2037 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2038 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2039 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2040 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2041 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2042 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2043 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2044 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002045 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2046 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002047
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002048set-dumpable
2049 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2050 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2051 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2052 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2053 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2054 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2055 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2056 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2057 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2058 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2059 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2060 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2061 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2062 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2063 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2064 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2065 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2066 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2067
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002068set-var <var-name> <expr>
2069 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2070 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2071 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2072 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2073 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2074 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002075 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002076 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2077 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2078
2079 Example:
2080 global
2081 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2082 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2083 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2084
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002085set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2086 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2087 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2088 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2089 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2090 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2091 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2092 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2093 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2094 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2095 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2096
2097 Example:
2098 global
2099 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2100 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2101
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002102setenv <name> <value>
2103 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2104 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2105 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2106 and "unsetenv".
2107
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002108ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2109 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2110 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002111 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002112 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002113 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2114 information and recommendations see e.g.
2115 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2116 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2117 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2118 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002119
2120ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2122 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2123 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2124 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2125 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002126 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2127 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2128 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002129 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002130
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002131ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2133 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2134 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2135 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2136 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2137
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002138ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2140 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2141 keyword to see available options.
2142
2143 Example:
2144 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002145 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002146
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002147ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2149 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002150 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002151 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002152 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2153 information and recommendations see e.g.
2154 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2155 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2156 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2157 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2158 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002159
2160ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2161 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2162 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2163 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2164 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2165 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002166 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2167 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2168 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2169 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002170
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002171ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2173 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2174 keyword to see available options.
2175
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002176ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2178 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2179 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002180 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002181 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002182 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002183 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2184 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2185 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2186 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002187 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2188 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2189 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2190
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002191ssl-propquery <query>
2192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2193 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2194 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2195 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2196 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2197 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2198 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2199 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2200 was not found.
2201
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002202ssl-provider <name>
2203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2204 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2205 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2206 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2207 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2208 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002209
2210 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002211 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2212 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2213 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2214 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2215 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002216
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002217 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2218 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2219 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2220 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002221
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002222 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2223
2224ssl-provider-path <path>
2225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2226 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2227 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2228 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2229 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2230 defined.
2231 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002232
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002233ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2234 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2235 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002236 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002237 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002238 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2239
2240 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002241
2242 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2243 and won't try to remove them.
2244
2245 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2246
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002247ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002248 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002249 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2250 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2251 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002252
2253 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2254 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2255 optimize the startup time.
2256
2257 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2258 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2259 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2260
2261 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002262 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002263
2264 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002265 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2266 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002267
2268 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2269 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2270 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2271 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2272 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002273 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002274
2275 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002276 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002277 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2278 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2279 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2280 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2281 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002282 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002283
2284 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2285
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002286 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002287 a cert bundle.
2288
2289 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2290 separately in several "crt".
2291
2292 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2293 since files are loading separately.
2294
2295 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2296 required to commit them.
2297
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002298 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002299 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002300
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002301 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2302 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2303 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002304
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002305 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2306 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2307 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002308
2309 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002310 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2311 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002312
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002313 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2314 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2315
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002316 The default behavior is "all".
2317
2318 Example:
2319 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2320 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2321 ssl-load-extra-files none
2322
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002323 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2324 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002325
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002326ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2327 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2328 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2329 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2330
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002331ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002332 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002333 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2334 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2335 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2336 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2337 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2338 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002339 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002340
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002341stats maxconn <connections>
2342 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2343 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2344
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002345stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2346 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2347 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2348 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002349 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002350 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002351
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002352 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2353 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2354 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002355
2356stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2357 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2358 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002359 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002360
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002361strict-limits
2362 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2363 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2364 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2365 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2366 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002367
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002368thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2369 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2370 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2371 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2372 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2373 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2374 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2375 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2376 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2377 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2378
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002379thread-groups <number>
2380 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2381 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002382 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2383 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2384 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2385 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2386 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002387
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002388trace <args...>
2389 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2390 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2391 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2392 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2393 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2394 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2395 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2396 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2397 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2398 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2399 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2400 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2401 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2402 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2403 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2404 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2405 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2406
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002407uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002408 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002409 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2410 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2411 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2412
2413ulimit-n <number>
2414 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2415 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002416 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2417 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002418
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002419 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2420 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2421 manually specify this value.
2422
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002423 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2424
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002425unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2426 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2427
2428 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2429 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2430 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2431 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2432 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002433 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002434 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2435 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2436 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2437 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2438
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002439unsetenv [<name> ...]
2440 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2441 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2442 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2443 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2444 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2445 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2446 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2447
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002448user <user name>
2449 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2450 See also "uid" and "group".
2451
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002452node <name>
2453 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2454
2455 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2456 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2457 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2458 traffic.
2459
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002460wurfl-cache-size <size>
2461 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2462 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2463 - "0" : no cache is used.
2464 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002465
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002466 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2467 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002468
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002469wurfl-data-file <file path>
2470 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2471 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2472
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002473 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002474 with USE_WURFL=1.
2475
2476wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2477 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2478 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2479 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2480
2481 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2482
2483 Valid WURFL properties are:
2484 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2485
2486 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2487 device.
2488
2489 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2490 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2491
2492 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2493 particular web request.
2494
2495 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2496 used Libwurfl API version.
2497
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002498 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2499 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2500
2501 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2502 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2503
2504 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2505
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002506 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002507 with USE_WURFL=1.
2508
2509wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2510 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2511 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2512
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002513 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002514 with USE_WURFL=1.
2515
2516wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2517 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2518 thus before the chroot.
2519
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002520 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002521 with USE_WURFL=1.
2522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025233.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002524-----------------------
2525
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002526busy-polling
2527 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2528 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2529 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2530 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2531 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2532 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2533 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2534 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2535 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2536 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2537 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2538 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2539 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2540 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2541 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2542 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2543 "poll" pollers.
2544
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002545 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2546 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2547 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2548
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002549max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002550 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002551 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2552 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2553 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2554 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2555 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2556 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2557 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2558
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002559maxcompcpuusage <number>
2560 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2561 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2562 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2563 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2564 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2565 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2566 and from introducing high latencies.
2567
2568maxcomprate <number>
2569 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2570 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2571 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2572 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2573 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2574 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2575 default value.
2576
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002577maxconn <number>
2578 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2579 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2580 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002581 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2582 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2583 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2584 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002585 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2586 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2587 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2588 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2589 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002590 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2591
2592 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002593
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002594maxconnrate <number>
2595 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2596 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2597 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2598 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2599 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2600 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2601 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2602 fairness.
2603
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002604maxpipes <number>
2605 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2606 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2607 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2608 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2609 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2610 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2611
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002612maxsessrate <number>
2613 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2614 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2615 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2616 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2617 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2618 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2619 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2620 fairness.
2621
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002622maxsslconn <number>
2623 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2624 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2625 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2626 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2627 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2628 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2629 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002630 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2631 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2632 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2633 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002634 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002635 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2636 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002637
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002638maxsslrate <number>
2639 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2640 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2641 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2642 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2643 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2644 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2645 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2646 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2647 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2648 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2649
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002650maxzlibmem <number>
2651 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2652 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2653 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002654 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2655 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2656 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2657
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002658no-memory-trimming
2659 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2660 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2661 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2662 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2663 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2664 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2665 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2666 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2667 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2668 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2669 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2670 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2671 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2672 not suffer from such a problem.
2673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002674noepoll
2675 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2676 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002677 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002678
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002679noevports
2680 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2681 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2682 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2683 also "nopoll".
2684
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002685nogetaddrinfo
2686 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2687 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2688
2689nokqueue
2690 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2691 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2692 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2693
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002694nopoll
2695 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2696 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002697 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002698 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2699 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002700
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002701noreuseport
2702 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2703 command line argument "-dR".
2704
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002705nosplice
2706 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002707 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002708 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002709 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002710 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2711 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2712 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2713 "option splice-response".
2714
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002715profiling.memory { on | off }
2716 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2717 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2718 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2719 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2720 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2721 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2722 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2723 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2724 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2725
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002726profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2727 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2728 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2729 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2730 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002731 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002732 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2733 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2734 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2735 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2736
2737 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2738 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2739 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2740 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2741 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002742 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2743 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2744 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2745 CLI.
2746
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002747spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002748 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2749 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2750 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2751 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2752 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2753 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002754
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002755ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002756 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002757 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002758 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002759 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002760 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2761 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2762 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002763 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2764 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002765 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2766 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2767 openssl configuration file uses:
2768 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2769
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002770ssl-mode-async
2771 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002772 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002773 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2774 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002775 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002776 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002777 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002778
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002779tune.buffers.limit <number>
2780 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2781 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2782 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2783 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2784 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002785 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002786 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2787 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2788 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2789 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2790 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2791 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2792 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2793 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002794 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002795
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002796tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2797 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2798 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2799 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002800 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002801
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002802tune.bufsize <number>
2803 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2804 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2805 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2806 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2807 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2808 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2809 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002810 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2811 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002812 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002813 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002814 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002815 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2816 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002817
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002818tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2819 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2820 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2821 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2822 this value. The default value is 1.
2823
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002824tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002825 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2826 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2827 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2828 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002829
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002830tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2831 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2832 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2833 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2834 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2835 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2836
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002837tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2838 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2839 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2840 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2841 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2842 change it.
2843
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002844tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2845 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002846 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002847 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002848 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002849 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2850 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2851 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2852 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2853
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002854tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2855 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2856 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2857 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2858 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2859 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002860 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002861 recommended not to change this value.
2862
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002863tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002864 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002865 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002866 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002867 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2868 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2869 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2870 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2871
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002872tune.http.cookielen <number>
2873 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2874 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2875 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2876 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2877 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2878 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2879 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2880 to change this value.
2881
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002882tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002883 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2884 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002885 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002887 configuration directives too.
2888 The default value is 1024.
2889
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002890tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2891 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2892 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2893 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2894 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2895 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2896 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002897 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2898 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2899 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002900
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002901tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2902 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2903 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2904 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2905 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2906 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2907 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002908 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2909 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2910 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2911 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2912 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002913
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002914tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002915 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002916 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2917 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2918 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2919 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002920 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002921 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002922 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002923 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2924
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002925tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2926 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2927 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2928 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2929 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2930 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2931 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2932 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2933 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2934 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2935
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002936tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2937 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002938 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002939 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2940 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002942 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2943 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2944
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002945tune.lua.maxmem
2946 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2947 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2948 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2949 memory.
2950
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002951tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2952 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002953 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2954 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002955 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002956
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002957tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2958 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2959 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2960 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002961 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002962
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002963tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2964 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2965 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2966 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2967 check servers.
2968
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002969tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002970 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2971 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002972 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2973 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2974 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2975 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2976 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2977 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2978 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2979 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2980 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002981
2982tune.maxpollevents <number>
2983 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2984 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2985 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2986 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2987 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2988
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002989tune.maxrewrite <number>
2990 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2991 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2992 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2993 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2994 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2995 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2996 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2997 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2998 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2999 bufsize.
3000
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003001tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3002 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3003 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3004 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3005 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3006 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3007 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3008 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3009 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3010 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3011 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3012 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3013 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3014 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3015 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3016
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003017tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3018 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3019 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3020 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3021 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3022 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3023 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3024 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3025 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3026 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003027 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3028 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003029 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3030 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3031 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3032 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3033 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3034 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3035 setting this parameter to 0.
3036
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003037tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3038 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3039 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3040 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3041 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3042 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3043 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3044 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3045
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003046tune.pipesize <number>
3047 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3048 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3049 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3050 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3051 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3052 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3053
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003054tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3055 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003056 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003057 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3058 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3059 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3060 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003061 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003062
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003063tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3064 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003065 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003066 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3067 default is 20.
3068
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003069tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003070 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3071 change without deprecation in the future.
3072
3073 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3074 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3075 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3076 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003077 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003078
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003079tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3080 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3081 change without deprecation in the future.
3082
3083 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3084 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3085 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3086 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3087 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3088 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3089 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3090
3091 The default value is 30000.
3092
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003093tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3094 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3095 change without deprecation in the future.
3096
3097 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3098 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3099 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3100 requests.
3101
3102 The default value is 100.
3103
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003104tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3105 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3106 change without deprecation in the future.
3107
3108 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003109 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3110 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003111 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3112 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003113 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3114 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003115
3116 The default value is 100.
3117
3118 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3119 information about QUIC retry.
3120
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003121tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3122 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3123 change without deprecation in the future.
3124
3125 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3126 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3127 own socket.
3128
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003129 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3130 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
3131 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. However, this relies on some
3132 advanced features from the UDP network stack. If your platform is deemed not
3133 compatible, haproxy will automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003134
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003135 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3136 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3137 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003138 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003139 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003140
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003141tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3142tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3143 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3144 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3145 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003146 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003148 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3149 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3150
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003151tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003152 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003153 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3154 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3155 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3156 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3157
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003158tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003159 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003160 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3161 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3162 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3163 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3164 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3165 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3166 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003167
3168tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3169 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003170 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003171 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3172 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3173 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3174 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3175 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3176 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3177 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003178
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003179tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3180tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3181 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3182 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3183 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003184 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003185 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003186 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3187 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3188 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3189 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003190 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003191
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003192tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003193 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003194 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3195 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3196 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3197 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3198 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3199 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3200 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3201 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3202 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003203 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3204 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003205
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003206tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3207tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3208 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3209 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3210 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3211 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3212
3213tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3214 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3215 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3216 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3217 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3218 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3219 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3220 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3221 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3222 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3223 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3224 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3225 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3226
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003227tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003228 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003229 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3230 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3231 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3232 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3233 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3234
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003235tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3236 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3237 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3238 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3239 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3240
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003241tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3242 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3243 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3244 performances. This is disabled by default.
3245
3246 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3247 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3248
3249 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3250
3251 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3252
3253 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3254
3255 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3256 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3257 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3258
3259 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3260 converted.
3261
3262 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3263 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3264 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3265 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3266 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3267 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3268 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003269 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3270 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003271
3272 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3273
3274 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3275 only need this line:
3276
3277 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3278
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003279tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3280 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003281 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003282 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3283 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3284 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3285 being used for too long.
3286
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003287tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003288 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3289 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3290 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3291 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3292 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3293 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3294 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3295 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3296 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3297 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3298 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3299 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3300 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003301
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003302tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3303 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3304 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3305 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3306 1000 entries.
3307
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003308tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003309tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003310tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3311tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3312tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003313 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3314 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3315 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3316 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3317 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3318 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3319 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3320 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003321
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003322 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3323 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3324 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3325 all available space is consumed.
3326 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3327 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3328 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003329
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003330tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3331 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003332 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003333 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003334 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003335 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3336
3337tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3338 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3339 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003340 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3341 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033433.3. Debugging
3344--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003345
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003346anonkey <key>
3347 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3348 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3349 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Erwan Le Goasb0c05012022-09-14 17:51:55 +02003350 from the CLI command "set global-key". See also command line argument "-dC"
3351 in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003352
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003353quick-exit
3354 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3355 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3356 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3357 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3358 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3359 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3360 do so by developers.
3361
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003362quiet
3363 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3364 line argument "-q".
3365
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003366zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003367 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003368 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3369 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3370 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3371 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3372 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3373
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010033753.4. Userlists
3376--------------
3377It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3378http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3379it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3380
3381userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003382 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003383 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3384
3385group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003386 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003387 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3388 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3389
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003390user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3391 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003392 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3393 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003394 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3395 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3396 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3397 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003398
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003399 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3400 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3401 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3402 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3403 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3404 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3405 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003406 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003407 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003408
3409 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003410 userlist L1
3411 group G1 users tiger,scott
3412 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003413
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003414 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3415 user scott insecure-password elgato
3416 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003417
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003418 userlist L2
3419 group G1
3420 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003421
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003422 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3423 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3424 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003425
3426 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003428
34293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003430----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003431It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003432several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003433instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003434values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3435type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3436values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3437active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3438switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3439present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3440watch it.
3441
3442Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3443known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3444the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3445process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3446during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3447tables.
3448
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003449Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3450that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3451each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003452
3453peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003454 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003455 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3456
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003457bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3458 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3459 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3460
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003461disabled
3462 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3463 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3464 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3465
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003466default-bind [param*]
3467 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3468
3469default-server [param*]
3470 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3471
3472 Arguments:
3473 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3474 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003475 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3476 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3477 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3478 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003479
3480 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3481
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003482enabled
3483 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3484 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003485
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003486log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003487 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3488 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3489 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3490 more details.
3491
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003492peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003493 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3494 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003495 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003496 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003497 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3498 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3499 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003500
3501 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3502 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3503
3504 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003505 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3506 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3507 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003508
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003509 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3510 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003511
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003512 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3513 "server" keyword explanation below).
3514
3515server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003516 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003517 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3518 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3519 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3520 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003521
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003522 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3523 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3524 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3525 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3526 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003527
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003528 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003529 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003530 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003531 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3532 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3533 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003534
3535 backend mybackend
3536 mode tcp
3537 balance roundrobin
3538 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3539 stick on src
3540
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003541 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3542 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003543
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003544 Example:
3545 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003546 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3547 default-server ssl verify none
3548 server haproxy1 #local peer
3549 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3550 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003551
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003552shards <shards>
3553
3554 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3555 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3556 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3557 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3558 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003559
3560table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3561 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3562
3563 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3564 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003565 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003566 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3567 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3568 "stick-table" keyword).
3569
3570 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3571 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3572 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3573 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3574 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3575 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3576 of the stick-table name as follows:
3577
3578 peers mypeers
3579 peer A ...
3580 peer B ...
3581 table t1 ...
3582
3583 frontend fe1
3584 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3585
3586 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3587 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3588
3589 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3590 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3591 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3592 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3593 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3594 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3595 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3596
3597 peers mypeers
3598 peer A ...
3599 peer B ...
3600 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3601
3602 backend t1
3603 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3604
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003605 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003606 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3607 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3608
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090036093.6. Mailers
3610------------
3611It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3612If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3613in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3614
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003615mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003616 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3617 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3618
3619mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3620 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3621
3622 Example:
3623 mailers mymailers
3624 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3625 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3626
3627 backend mybackend
3628 mode tcp
3629 balance roundrobin
3630
3631 email-alert mailers mymailers
3632 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3633 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3634
3635 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3636 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3637
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003638timeout mail <time>
3639 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3640 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3641 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3642 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3643
3644 Example:
3645 mailers mymailers
3646 timeout mail 20s
3647 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003648
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020036493.7. Programs
3650-------------
3651In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3652master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3653managed the same way as the workers.
3654
3655During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3656sequence as a worker:
3657
3658 - the master is re-executed
3659 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3660 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3661 instance of the program
3662
3663During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3664
3665program <name>
3666 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3667 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3668 the management guide).
3669
3670command <command> [arguments*]
3671 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3672 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3673 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3674 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3675
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003676user <user name>
3677 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3678 See also "group".
3679
3680group <group name>
3681 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3682 See also "user".
3683
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003684option start-on-reload
3685no option start-on-reload
3686 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3687 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3688 program section.
3689
3690
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010036913.8. HTTP-errors
3692----------------
3693
3694It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3695imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3696several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3697
3698http-errors <name>
3699 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3700 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3701
3702errorfile <code> <file>
3703 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3704
3705 Arguments :
3706 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003707 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003708 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003709
3710 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3711 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3712 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3713 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3714 before any chroot is performed.
3715
3716 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3717
3718 Example:
3719 http-errors website-1
3720 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3721 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3722 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3723
3724 http-errors website-2
3725 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3726 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3727 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3728
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020037293.9. Rings
3730----------
3731
3732It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3733servers or traces.
3734
3735ring <ringname>
3736 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3737
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003738backing-file <path>
3739 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3740 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3741 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3742 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3743 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3744 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3745 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3746
3747 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3748 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3749 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3750 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003751 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3752 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3753 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3754 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3755 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3756 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3757 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3758 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3759 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3760 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3761 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3762 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003763
3764 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3765 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3766 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3767 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3768 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3769 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3770 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3771
3772 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3773 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3774 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3775
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003776description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003777 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003778 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3779
3780format <format>
3781 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3782
3783 Arguments:
3784 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3785 one of the following :
3786
3787 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3788 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3789 designed to be used with a local log server.
3790
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003791 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3792 field is stripped. This is the default.
3793 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3794 rfc3164.
3795
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003796 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3797 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3798 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3799 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3800 is the default.
3801
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003802 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003803 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3804
3805 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3806 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3807
3808 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3809 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3810 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3811 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3812 logger consumes.
3813
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003814 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3815 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3816 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3817 with a local log server.
3818
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003819 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3820 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3821 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3822 used with a local log server.
3823
3824maxlen <length>
3825 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3826 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3827 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3828
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003829server <name> <address> [param*]
3830 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3831 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3832 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3833 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3834 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3835 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3836 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3837 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3838 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003839 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3840 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003841
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003842size <size>
3843 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3844 set to BUFSIZE.
3845
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003846timeout connect <timeout>
3847 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3848
3849 Arguments :
3850 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3851 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3852 as explained at the top of this document.
3853
3854timeout server <timeout>
3855 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3856
3857 Arguments :
3858 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3859 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3860 as explained at the top of this document.
3861
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003862 Example:
3863 global
3864 log ring@myring local7
3865
3866 ring myring
3867 description "My local buffer"
3868 format rfc3164
3869 maxlen 1200
3870 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003871 timeout connect 5s
3872 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003873 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003874
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020038753.10. Log forwarding
3876-------------------
3877
3878It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003879HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003880
3881log-forward <name>
3882 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3883
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003884backlog <conns>
3885 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3886 on connections accept.
3887
3888bind <addr> [param*]
3889 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003890 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3891 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3892 syslog protocol over TCP.
3893 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003894 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3895
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003896dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003897 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3898 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3899 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3900 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003901 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003902
3903log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003904log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003905 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3906 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3907 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003908 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003909 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3910 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3911 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003912 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003913
3914 Example:
3915 global
3916 log stderr format iso local7
3917
3918 ring myring
3919 description "My local buffer"
3920 format rfc5424
3921 maxlen 1200
3922 size 32764
3923 timeout connect 5s
3924 timeout server 10s
3925 # syslog tcp server
3926 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3927
3928 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003929 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3930 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003931 # all messages on stderr
3932 log global
3933 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3934 log ring@myring local0
3935 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3936 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3937 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3938 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3939 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003940
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003941maxconn <conns>
3942 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3943 10 is the default.
3944
3945timeout client <timeout>
3946 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039484. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003949----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003951Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003952 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3953 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3954 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3955 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003956
3957A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3958connections.
3959
3960A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3961to forward incoming connections.
3962
3963A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3964parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3965
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003966A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3967ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3968sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3969the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3970explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3971from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3972"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3973for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3974to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3975optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3976are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3977any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3978names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3979that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3980duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003981names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3982is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3983implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3984encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3985adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003986
3987Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3988settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3989of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3990profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3991timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3992
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003993All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3994'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3995case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3996
3997Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3998logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3999proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4000However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4001name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4002
4003Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4004and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004005bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4007modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4008arbitrary criteria.
4009
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004010In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4011a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004012the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004013
4014 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4015 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4016 between responses and new requests.
4017
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004018 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4019 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4020 client-facing connection remains open.
4021
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004022 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4023 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004024
4025The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4026frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4027following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004028weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004029
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004030 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004031
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004032 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4033 ----+-----+-----+----
4034 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4035 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004036 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4037 ----+-----+-----+----
4038 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004039
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004040It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004041only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4042within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004043as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004044content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004045and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4046possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004048There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004049first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004050processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004051second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004052protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4053is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4054new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004055to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004056process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4057already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4058HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4059evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4060one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4061
4062There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4063performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4064tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4065preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4066analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4067HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4068header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4069mitigate this drawback.
4070
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004071There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004072method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4073set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4074in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4075is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4076to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4077above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4078to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4079"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4080frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4081frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4082as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4083upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4084on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4085the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4086upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4087frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4088remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020040904.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4091--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004093The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4094limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4095they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4096limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004097marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004098option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004099and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4100with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004101specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4102sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4103anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004104
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004105
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004106 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4107------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004108acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004109backlog X X X -
4110balance X - X X
4111bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004112capture cookie - X X -
4113capture request header - X X -
4114capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004115clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4116clitcpka-idle X X X -
4117clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004118compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004119cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004120declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004121default-server X - X X
4122default_backend X X X -
4123description - X X X
4124disabled X X X X
4125dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004126email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004127email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004128email-alert mailers X X X X
4129email-alert myhostname X X X X
4130email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004131enabled X X X X
4132errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004133errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004134errorloc X X X X
4135errorloc302 X X X X
4136-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4137errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004138error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004139force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004140filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004141fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004142hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004143http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004144http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004145http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004146http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004147http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004148http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004149http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004150http-check set-var X - X X
4151http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004152http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004153http-request X (!) X X X
4154http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004155http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02004156http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004157id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004158ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004159load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004160log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004161log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004162log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004163log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004164max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004165maxconn X X X -
4166mode X X X X
4167monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004168monitor-uri X X X -
4169option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4170option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4171option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4172option allbackups (*) X - X X
4173option checkcache (*) X - X X
4174option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4175option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004176option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004177option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4178option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004179-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4180option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004181option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4182option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004183option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004184option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004185option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004186option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004187option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004188option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004189option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4190option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4191option httpchk X - X X
4192option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004193option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004194option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004195option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004196option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004197option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004198option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4199option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4200option logasap (*) X X X -
4201option mysql-check X - X X
4202option nolinger (*) X X X X
4203option originalto X X X X
4204option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004205option pgsql-check X - X X
4206option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004207option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004208option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004209option smtpchk X - X X
4210option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4211option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4212option splice-request (*) X X X X
4213option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01004214option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004215option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4216option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4217-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004218option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004219option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4220option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4221option tcpka X X X X
4222option tcplog X X X X
4223option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004224option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004225external-check command X - X X
4226external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004227persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4228rate-limit sessions X X X -
4229redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004230-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004231retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004232retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004233server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004234server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004235server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004236source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004237srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4238srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4239srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004240stats admin - X X X
4241stats auth X X X X
4242stats enable X X X X
4243stats hide-version X X X X
4244stats http-request - X X X
4245stats realm X X X X
4246stats refresh X X X X
4247stats scope X X X X
4248stats show-desc X X X X
4249stats show-legends X X X X
4250stats show-node X X X X
4251stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004252-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4253stick match - - X X
4254stick on - - X X
4255stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004256stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004257stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004258tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004259tcp-check connect X - X X
4260tcp-check expect X - X X
4261tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004262tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004263tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004264tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004265tcp-check set-var X - X X
4266tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004267tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4268tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4269tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4270tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4271tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4272tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004273timeout check X - X X
4274timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004275timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004276timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004277timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4278timeout http-request X X X X
4279timeout queue X - X X
4280timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004281timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004282timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004283timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004284transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004285unique-id-format X X X -
4286unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004287use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004288use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004289use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004290------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4291 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004292
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020042944.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4295---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296
4297This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4298
4299
4300acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4301 Declare or complete an access list.
4302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004303 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4304
4305 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4306 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4307 using it.
4308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 Example:
4310 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4311 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4312 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004314 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
4316
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004317backlog <conns>
4318 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4320 yes | yes | yes | no
4321 Arguments :
4322 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4323 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004324 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004325
4326 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4327 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4328 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4329 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4330 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4331 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4332 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4333 backlog parameter.
4334
4335 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4336 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4337 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4338
4339 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4340
4341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004342balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004343balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004344 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4346 yes | no | yes | yes
4347 Arguments :
4348 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4349 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4350 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4351 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4352
4353 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4354 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4355 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4356 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004357 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004358 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004359 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4360 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4361 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4362 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4363 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4364 it, so that you don't worry.
4365
4366 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4367 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4368 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4369 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4370 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4371 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4372 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4373 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004374
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004375 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4376 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4377 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4378 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4379 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4380 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4381 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004382 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4383 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4384 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004385
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004386 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004387 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004388 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4389 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004390 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004391 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4392 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4393 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4394 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4395 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004396 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4397 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4398 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4399 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4400 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4401 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004402
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004403 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4404 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4405 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4406 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4407 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4408 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4409 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4410 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4411 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4412 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4413 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4414 changed using "hash-type".
4415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004416 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4417 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4418 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4419 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4420 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4421 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4422 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4423 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004424 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004425 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004426 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4427 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004428 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004429
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004430 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4431 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4432 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4433 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4434 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4435 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4436 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4437 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4438 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4439 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4440 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4441 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004443 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004444 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4445 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4446 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4447 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4448 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4449 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4450 URIs start with a leading "/".
4451
4452 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4453 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4454 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4455 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4456
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004457 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4458 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4459 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004460 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4461 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004464 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4465
4466 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004467 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4468 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004469 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4470 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4471 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4472 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004473 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004474 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4475 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004476
4477 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4478 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4479 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4480 server will receive the request.
4481
4482 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4483 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4484 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4485 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4486 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004487 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4488 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004489 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4490 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004491
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004492 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4493 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4494 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4495 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4496 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004498 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004499 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4500 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4501 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4502
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004503 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4504 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004505 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4506 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004507
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004508 random
4509 random(<draws>)
4510 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004511 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4512 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4513 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4514 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004515 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4516 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4517 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4518 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4519 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4520 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4521 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4522 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4523 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4524 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4525 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4526 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4527 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4528 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4529 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4530 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4531 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4532 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4533 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4534 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004535
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004536 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004537 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004538 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4539 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004540 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004541 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4542 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4543 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004544 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004545 used instead.
4546
4547 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4548 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4549 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004550 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004551
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004552 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4553 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004554 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4555 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004556
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004557 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004558 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4559 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004560
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004561 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4562 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4563 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004564
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004565 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004566 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004567 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4568 NTLM relies on.
4569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004570 Examples :
4571 balance roundrobin
4572 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004573 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004574 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4575 balance hdr(host)
4576 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004577 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4578 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4579 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004580
4581 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4582 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004584 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004585 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4586 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4587 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004588 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004589
4590 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4591 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4592 defaults to 16 kB.
4593
4594 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4595 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4596
4597 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4598 Round Robin.
4599
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004600 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004601 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4602 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4603 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4604
4605 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4606
4607 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004608 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004609 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4610 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4611 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004612
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004613 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004614
4615
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004616bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4617bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004618 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 no | yes | yes | no
4621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004622 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4623 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4624 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4625 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004626 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4627 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4628 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4629 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4630 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004631 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4632 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4633 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4634 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4635 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4636 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004637 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004638 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4639 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004640 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004641 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4642 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004643 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004644 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4645 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004646 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004647 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004648 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4649 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4650 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004651 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4652 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4653 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4654 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004655 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004656 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4657 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4658 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4659 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4660 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4661 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4662 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004663 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004664 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4665 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004666
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004667 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4668 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4669 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004670
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004671 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4672 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004673 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4674 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4675 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004676 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4677 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4678 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4679 the range.
4680
4681 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4682 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4683 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4684 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4685 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4686 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4687 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004688 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004689 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004691 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004692 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004693 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4694 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4695 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4696 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4697 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4698 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4699
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004700 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4701 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4702 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4703 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004704
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004705 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4706 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4707 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4708 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4709 in a frontend.
4710
4711 Example :
4712 listen http_proxy
4713 bind :80,:443
4714 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004715 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004716
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004717 listen http_https_proxy
4718 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004719 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004720
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004721 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4722 bind ipv6@:80
4723 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4724 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4725
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004726 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004727 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004728
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004729 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004730 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004731
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004732 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4733 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4734 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4735 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4736 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4737
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004738 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004739 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004740
4741
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004742capture cookie <name> len <length>
4743 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 no | yes | yes | no
4746 Arguments :
4747 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4748 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4749 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4750 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004751 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004752
4753 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4754 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4755 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4756 right if it exceeds <length>.
4757
4758 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4759 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4760 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4761 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4762
4763 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4764 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4765 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4766
4767 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4768 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4769 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004770 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4771 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4772 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004773
4774 Example:
4775 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4776
4777 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004778 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004779
4780
4781capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004782 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 no | yes | yes | no
4785 Arguments :
4786 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004787 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004788 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4789 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4790 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4791
4792 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4793 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4794 it exceeds <length>.
4795
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004796 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004797 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4798 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004799 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4800 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4801 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4802 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004803 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004804 environments to find where the request came from.
4805
4806 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4807 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4808 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4809 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004810
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004811 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4812 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4813 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4814 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4815 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004816
4817 Example:
4818 capture request header Host len 15
4819 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004820 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004822 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823 about logging.
4824
4825
4826capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004827 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 no | yes | yes | no
4830 Arguments :
4831 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004832 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004833 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4834 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4835 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4836
4837 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4838 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4839 it exceeds <length>.
4840
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004841 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4843 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4844 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004845 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4846 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4847 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4848 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004849
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004850 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4851 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4852 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4853 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4854 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004855
4856 Example:
4857 capture response header Content-length len 9
4858 capture response header Location len 15
4859
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004860 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004861 about logging.
4862
4863
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004864clitcpka-cnt <count>
4865 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4866 the connection on the client side.
4867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4868 yes | yes | yes | no
4869 Arguments :
4870 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4871
4872 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4873 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004874 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4875 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004876
4877 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4878
4879
4880clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4881 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4882 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4883 client side.
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | no
4886 Arguments :
4887 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4888 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4889 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4890 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4891
4892 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4893 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004894 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4895 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004896
4897 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4898
4899
4900clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4901 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4903 yes | yes | yes | no
4904 Arguments :
4905 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4906 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4907 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4908 document.
4909
4910 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4911 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004912 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4913 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004914
4915 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4916
4917
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004918compression algo <algorithm> ...
4919compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004920 Enable HTTP compression.
4921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4922 yes | yes | yes | yes
4923 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004924 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4925 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004926
4927 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004928 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4929 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4930 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004931
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004932 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004933 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004934
4935 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4936 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4937 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4938 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4939 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004940 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004941
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004942 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4943 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4944 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4945 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4946 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4947 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4948 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004949 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004950
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004951 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004952 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004953 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004954 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004955 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004956 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004957 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004958
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004959 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004960 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4961 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004962 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004963 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004964 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4965 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4966 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4967 "multipart"
4968 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4969 header
4970 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4971 and later
4972 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4973 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004974 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004975
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004976 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004977
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004978 Examples :
4979 compression algo gzip
4980 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004981
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004982 See also : "compression offload"
4983
4984compression offload
4985 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4987 no | yes | yes | yes
4988
4989 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4990 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4991 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4992 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4993 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4994 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4995 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4996 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4997 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4998 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4999 then be used for such scenarios.
5000
5001 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5002 option is ignored.
5003
5004 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005005
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005006cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005007 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5008 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005009 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005010 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5012 yes | no | yes | yes
5013 Arguments :
5014 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5015 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5016 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5017 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5018 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5019 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005020 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005021 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5022 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5023
5024 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005025 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005026 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5027 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5028 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5029 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005030 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5031 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005032 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005033 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5034 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005035
5036 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005037 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005038
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005039 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005040 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005041 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005042 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005043 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5044 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5045 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5046 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5047 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5048 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5049 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005050
5051 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5052 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5053 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5054 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5055 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5056 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5057 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5058 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5059 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005060 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005061 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5062 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5063 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005064
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005065 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5066 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5067 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005068 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5069 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5070 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5071 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005072 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5073 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5074 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005075
5076 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5077 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5078 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5079 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5080 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5081 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5082 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5083 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5084 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5085
5086 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5087 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5088 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5089 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5090 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5091 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5092 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5093 persistence cookie in the cache.
5094 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5095
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005096 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5097 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005098 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005099 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5100 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005101 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005102 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5103 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5104 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5105 they logout.
5106
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005107 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005108 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5109 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5110 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5111
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005112 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005113 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5114 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5115 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5116 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5117 this attribute.
5118
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005119 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005120 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005121 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5122 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5123 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5124 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5125 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5126 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005127
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005128 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5129 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5130 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5131 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5132 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5133 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5134 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5135 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005136 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005137 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5138 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5139 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5140 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5141 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5142 the site.
5143
5144 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5145 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5146 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5147 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5148 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5149 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5150 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5151 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5152 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5153 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5154 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5155 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5156 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005157 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005158 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5159 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5160
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005161 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5162 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5163 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5164 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5165 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5166 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005168 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005169 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5170 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5171 repeated.
5172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005173 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5174 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5175 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5176 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005177
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005178 Examples :
5179 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5180 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5181 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005182 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005183
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005184 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005185
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005186
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005187declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5188 Declares a capture slot.
5189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 no | yes | yes | no
5191 Arguments:
5192 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5193
5194 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5195 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5196 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5197 for use in the response.
5198
5199 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005200 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005201 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5202
5203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005204default-server [param*]
5205 Change default options for a server in a backend
5206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
5208 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005209 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5210 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5211 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5212 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005213
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005214 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005215 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5216
5217 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005218
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005220default_backend <backend>
5221 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5223 yes | yes | yes | no
5224 Arguments :
5225 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5226
5227 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5228 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5229 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5230 will catch all undetermined requests.
5231
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005232 Example :
5233
5234 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5235 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5236 default_backend dynamic
5237
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005238 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005239
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005240
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005241description <string>
5242 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5244 no | yes | yes | yes
5245 Arguments : string
5246
5247 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5248 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5249 it describes.
5250 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5251
5252
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005253disabled
5254 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5256 yes | yes | yes | yes
5257 Arguments : none
5258
5259 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5260 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5261 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5262 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5263 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5264 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5265 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5266
5267 See also : "enabled"
5268
5269
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005270dispatch <address>:<port>
5271 Set a default server address
5272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5273 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005274 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005275
5276 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5277 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5278 during start-up.
5279
5280 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5281 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5282 possible with normal servers.
5283
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005284 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005285 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5286 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5287 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5288 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5289
5290 See also : "server"
5291
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005292
5293dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5294 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | no | yes | yes
5297 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5298
5299 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005300 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005301 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5302 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005303 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005304 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005306enabled
5307 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5309 yes | yes | yes | yes
5310 Arguments : none
5311
5312 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5313 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5314
5315 See also : "disabled"
5316
5317
5318errorfile <code> <file>
5319 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | yes | yes | yes
5322 Arguments :
5323 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005324 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005325 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005326
5327 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005328 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005329 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005330 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5331 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005332
5333 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5334 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5335 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5336
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005337 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5338
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005339 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5340 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5341 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5342 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5343 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5344 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5345 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5346 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5347 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005348
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005349 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5350 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5351 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005352 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005353 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5354
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005355 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005356
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005357 Example :
5358 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005359 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005360 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5361 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005363
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005364errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5365 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5366 section.
5367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5368 yes | yes | yes | yes
5369 Arguments :
5370 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5371
5372 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005373 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005374 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5375 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005376
5377 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5378 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5379 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5380 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5381 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005382 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005383 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5384
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005385 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5386 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005387
5388 Example :
5389 errorfiles generic
5390 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5391
5392
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005393errorloc <code> <url>
5394errorloc302 <code> <url>
5395 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | yes | yes | yes
5398 Arguments :
5399 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005400 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005401 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005402
5403 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5404 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5405 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5406 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005407 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005408
5409 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5410 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5411 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5412
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005413 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5414
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005415 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5416 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5417 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5418 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005419 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005420 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5421 request.
5422
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005423 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005424
5425
5426errorloc303 <code> <url>
5427 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | yes | yes | yes
5430 Arguments :
5431 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005432 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005433 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005434
5435 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5436 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5437 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5438 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005439 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005440
5441 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5442 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5443 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5444
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005445 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5446
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005447 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5448 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5449 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5450 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005451 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005452
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005453 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005454
5455
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005456email-alert from <emailaddr>
5457 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005458 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005459 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | yes | yes | yes
5461
5462 Arguments :
5463
5464 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5465
5466 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5467 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5468
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005469 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005470 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5471 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005472
5473
5474email-alert level <level>
5475 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5476 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5478 yes | yes | yes | yes
5479
5480 Arguments :
5481
5482 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5483 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5484 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5485
5486 By default level is alert
5487
5488 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5489 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5490 for the proxy.
5491
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005492 Alerts are sent when :
5493
5494 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5495 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5496 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5497 is notice or lower
5498 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5499 and a health check status update occurs
5500
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005501 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5502 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005503 section 3.6 about mailers.
5504
5505
5506email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5507 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5509 yes | yes | yes | yes
5510
5511 Arguments :
5512
5513 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5514
5515 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5516 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5517
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005518 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5519 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005520
5521
5522email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5523 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5524 mailers.
5525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5526 yes | yes | yes | yes
5527
5528 Arguments :
5529
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005530 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005531
5532 By default the systems hostname is used.
5533
5534 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5535 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5536 for the proxy.
5537
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005538 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5539 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005540
5541
5542email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005543 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005544 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5546 yes | yes | yes | yes
5547
5548 Arguments :
5549
5550 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5551
5552 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5553 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5554
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005555 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005556 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5557
5558
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005559error-log-format <string>
5560 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 yes | yes | yes | no
5563
5564 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5565 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5566 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5567 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005568 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5569
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005570 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5571 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5572 string in depth.
5573
5574 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5575 directives.
5576
5577
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005578force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5579 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005581 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005582
5583 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5584 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5585 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5586 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5587 marked down for maintenance operations.
5588
5589 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5590 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5591 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5592 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5593 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5594 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5595 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5596 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5597 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5598
5599 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5600 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5601 is used.
5602
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005603 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005604 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005605
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005606
5607filter <name> [param*]
5608 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5610 no | yes | yes | yes
5611 Arguments :
5612 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5613 referenced in section 9.
5614
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005615 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005616 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005617 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5618 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005619
5620 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5621 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5622
5623 Example:
5624 listen
5625 bind *:80
5626
5627 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5628 filter compression
5629 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5630
5631 compression algo gzip
5632 compression offload
5633
5634 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5635
5636 See also : section 9.
5637
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005638
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005639fullconn <conns>
5640 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5642 yes | no | yes | yes
5643 Arguments :
5644 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5645 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5646
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005647 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005648 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005649 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005650 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5651 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5652 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5653 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5654 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005655 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005656
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005657 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005658 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005659 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5660 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5661 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005663 Example :
5664 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5665 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5666 # connections.
5667 backend dynamic
5668 fullconn 10000
5669 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5670 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5671
5672 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5673
5674
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005675hash-balance-factor <factor>
5676 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5678 yes | no | no | yes
5679 Arguments :
5680 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5681 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005682 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005683
5684 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5685 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5686 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5687 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5688 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5689 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5690 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5691
5692 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5693 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5694 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5695 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5696 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5697
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005698 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5699 consistent hashing mechanism.
5700
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005701 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5702
5703
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005704hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005705 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5707 yes | no | yes | yes
5708 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005709 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5710 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005711
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005712 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5713 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5714 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5715 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5716 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5717 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5718 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5719 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5720 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5721 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005722
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005723 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5724 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5725 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5726 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5727 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5728 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5729 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5730 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5731 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5732 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5733 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5734 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5735 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005736 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5737 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005738
5739 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5740
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005741 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005742 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5743 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5744 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005745 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5746 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5747 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005748
5749 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5750 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005751 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5752 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5753 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5754 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5755
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005756 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005757 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5758 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5759 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5760 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5761 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5762 parameter.
5763
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005764 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5765 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5766 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5767 used on strings.
5768
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005769 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5770
5771 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5772 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5773 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5774 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5775 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5776 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5777 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5778 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5779 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5780 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5781 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5782 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005783
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005784 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5785 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5786 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005787
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005788 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005789
5790
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005791http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5792 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5793 ones).
5794
5795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005796 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005797
5798 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5799 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5800 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5801 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5802 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5803 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5804
5805 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5806 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5807 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5808
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005809 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5810 supported:
5811 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5812 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005813 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005814 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5815 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5816 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5817 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5818 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005819 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5820 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005821 - strict-mode { on | off }
5822 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5823
5824 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005825
5826 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5827 instance.
5828
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005829 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5830 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5831 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5832 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5833 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5834 a defaults section defining such rules.
5835
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005836 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5837 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5838 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5839
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005840 Example:
5841 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5842 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5843 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5844
5845http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5846
5847 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005848 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5849 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005850
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005851http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5852
5853 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5854 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5855 complete description.
5856
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005857http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5858
5859 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005860 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005861
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005862http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005863
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005864 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5865 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005866
5867http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5868 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5869
5870 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5871
5872 Example:
5873 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5874
5875 # applied to:
5876 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5877
5878 # outputs:
5879 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5880
5881 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5882
5883http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5885
5886 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5887
5888 Example:
5889 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5890
5891 # applied to:
5892 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5893
5894 # outputs:
5895 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5896
5897http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5898
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005899 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5900 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5901 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5902 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005903
5904http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5905 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5906
5907 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005908 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005909 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005910
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005911http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5912http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005913
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005914 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5915 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5916 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005917
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005918http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005919
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005920 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5921 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005922
5923http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5924
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005925 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5926 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005927
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005928
5929http-check comment <string>
5930 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5931 it fails.
5932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5933 yes | no | yes | yes
5934
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005935 Arguments :
5936 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5937 rule fails.
5938
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005939 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5940 user-friendly error reporting.
5941
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005942 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005943 "http-check expect".
5944
5945
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005946http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5947 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005948 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005949 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5951 yes | no | yes | yes
5952
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005953 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005954 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5955
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005956 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005957 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005958
5959 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5960 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5961 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5962 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5963
5964 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5965
5966 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5967
5968 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5969
5970 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5971
5972 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5973
5974 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5975 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5976 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5977 is used.
5978
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005979 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5980 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5981 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5982 haproxy -vv.
5983
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005984 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5985
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005986 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5987 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5988 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5989 different ports or with different servers.
5990
5991 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5992 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5993 the port with a "http-check connect".
5994
5995 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5996 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5997 do.
5998
5999 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6000 unset-var or comment rules.
6001
6002 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006003 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6004 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6005 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6006 option httpchk
6007
6008 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006009 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006010 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006011 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006012 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006013 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006014
6015 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6016
6017 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006018
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006019
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006020http-check disable-on-404
6021 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006023 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006024 Arguments : none
6025
6026 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6027 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6028 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6029 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6030 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6031 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6032 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6033 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006034 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6035 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006036 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6037 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6038 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006039
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006040 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006041
6042
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006043http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006044 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6045 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6046 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006047 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006049 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006050
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006051 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006052 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6053
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006054 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6055 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6056 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6057 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6058 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6059 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6060 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6061 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6062 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6063 result is always conclusive.
6064
6065 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6066 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6067 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006068 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6069 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006070 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6071 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006072 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6073 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6074 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006075
6076 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6077 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006078 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6079 supported :
6080 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6081 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006082 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6083 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6084 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6085 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6086 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006087
6088 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6089 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006090 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6091 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6092 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6093 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006094 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6095
6096 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6097 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6098 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6099 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6100
6101 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6102 informational message reported in logs if an error
6103 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6104 log-format string.
6105
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006106 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006107 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6108 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006109 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6110 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6111 details on the supported keywords.
6112
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006113 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6114 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6115 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6116 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006117
6118 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6119 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6120 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6121 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6122 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6123
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006124 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6125 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6126 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6127 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6128 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6129 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6130 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006131
6132 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006133 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006134 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6135 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6136 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6137 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6138
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006139 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6140 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006141 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6142 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6143 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6144 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6145 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6146 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6147 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6148 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006149 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6150 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6151 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6152 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6153 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6154 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6155 insensitive on the header names.
6156
6157 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6158 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6159 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6160 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6161 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6162 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006163
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006164 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006165 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006166 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6167 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6168 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6169 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6170 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006171 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006172 trace).
6173
6174 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006175 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006176 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6177 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6178 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6179 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6180 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006181 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006182
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006183 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6184 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6185 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6186 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6187 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6188 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6189
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006190 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006191 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006192 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6193 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6194 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6195 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6196 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6197 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6198
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006199 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6200 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6201 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6202 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6203 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006204
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006205 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6206 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6207
6208 Examples :
6209 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006210 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006211
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006212 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6213 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6214
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006215 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006216 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006217
6218 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006219 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006220
6221 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006222 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006223
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006224 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006225 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006226
6227
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006228http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006229 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6230 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006231 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6232 health checks.
6233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | no | yes | yes
6235 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006236 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6237
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006238 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6239 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6240 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6241 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6242 to invent non-standard ones.
6243
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006244 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6245 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6246 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6247 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6248
6249 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6250 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6251 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6252 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006253
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006254 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006255 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006256 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006257 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6258 to add it.
6259
6260 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6261 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6262 to the log-format rules.
6263
6264 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6265 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6266 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006267
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006268 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6269 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6270 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6271 request.
6272
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006273 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6274 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6275 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006276 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6277 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6278 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6279 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006280 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006281
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006282 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006283 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6284 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006285
6286 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6287 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6288 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6289 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6290 configured request authority.
6291
6292 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6293 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006294
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006295 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006296
6297
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006298http-check send-state
6299 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6301 yes | no | yes | yes
6302 Arguments : none
6303
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006304 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006305 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006306 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6307 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6308 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006309
6310 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6311 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6312 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6313 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6314 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006315 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6316 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6317 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6318
6319 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6320 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6321 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6322
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006323 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6324 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6325 checked in multiple backends.
6326
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006327 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006328 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6329
6330 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6331 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6332 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6333 one fails.
6334
6335 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6336 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6337 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6338
6339 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6340 server's queue.
6341
6342 Example of a header received by the application server :
6343 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6344 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6345
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006346 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6347 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006348
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006349
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006350http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6351http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006352 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006353 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 yes | no | yes | yes
6355
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006356 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006357 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6358 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6359 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6360 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6361 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6362 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6363 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6364 and '-'.
6365
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006366 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6367 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006368 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006369 conditions.
6370
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006371 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6372
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006373 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6374 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6375
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006376 Examples :
6377 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006378 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006379
6380
6381http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006382 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006383 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6384 yes | no | yes | yes
6385
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006386 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006387 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6388 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6389 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6390 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6391 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6392 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6393 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6394 and '-'.
6395
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006396 Examples :
6397 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006399
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006400http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6401 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6402 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6403 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6404 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6406 yes | yes | yes | yes
6407 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006408 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006409 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006410 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006411 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006412
6413 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6414 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6415 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6416 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6417
6418 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6419 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6420 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6421 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6422
6423 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6424 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6425 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6426 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6427 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6428 chroot is performed.
6429
6430 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6431 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6432 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6433 considered.
6434
6435 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6436 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6437 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6438 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6439 considered as a raw string.
6440
6441 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6442 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6443 "content-type".
6444
6445 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6446 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6447 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6448 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6449 evaluated as a log-format string.
6450
6451 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6452 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6453 argument to "content-type".
6454
6455 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6456 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6457 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6458 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6459
6460 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6461 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6462 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6463 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6464 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6465 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6466 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6467 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6468
6469 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6470 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6471 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6472
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006473 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6474 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6475 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6476 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6477 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6478
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006479 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6480 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6481
6482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006483http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006484 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6485
6486 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006487 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006488
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006489 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6490 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6491 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6492 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6493 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006494
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006495 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6496 supported:
6497 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6498 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6499 - allow
6500 - auth [realm <realm>]
6501 - cache-use <name>
6502 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6503 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6504 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6505 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6506 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6507 - disable-l7-retry
6508 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6509 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6510 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6511 - redirect <rule>
6512 - reject
6513 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6514 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6515 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6516 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6517 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6518 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6519 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6520 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6521 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6522 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6523 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02006524 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006525 - set-dst <expr>
6526 - set-dst-port <expr>
6527 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6528 - set-log-level <level>
6529 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6530 - set-mark <mark>
6531 - set-method <fmt>
6532 - set-nice <nice>
6533 - set-path <fmt>
6534 - set-pathq <fmt>
6535 - set-priority-class <expr>
6536 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6537 - set-query <fmt>
6538 - set-src <expr>
6539 - set-src-port <expr>
6540 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6541 - set-tos <tos>
6542 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006543 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6544 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006545 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006546 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006547 - strict-mode { on | off }
6548 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6549 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6550 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6551 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6552 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6553 - use-service <service-name>
6554 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6555 - wait-for-handshake
6556 - cache-use <name>
6557
6558 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006560 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006561
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006562 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6563 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6564 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6565 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6566 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6567 a defaults section defining such rules.
6568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569 Example:
6570 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6571 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6572 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006574 http-request allow if nagios
6575 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6576 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6577 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006579 Example:
6580 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6581 acl add path /addacl
6582 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006585
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006586 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6587 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 Example:
6590 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6591 acl setmap path /setmap
6592 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6597 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6600 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6605 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6606 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6607 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6608 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6609 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6610 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6611 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6616 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6617 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6618 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6619 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6620 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6621 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6622 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006627 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006629http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006631 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6632 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6633 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6634 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6635 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006636
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006637 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6638 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6639 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6640 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6641 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6642 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6643 instead.
6644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 Example:
6646 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6647 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006648
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006649http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006650
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006651 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006652
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006653http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6654 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006656 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6657 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6658 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6659 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6660 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6661 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6662 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6663 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6664 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6667 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6668 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006669 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6670
6671 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6672 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6673 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6674 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006678 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6679 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6680 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6681 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6682 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6683 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006684
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006685http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006686
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006687 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6688 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6689 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6690 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6691 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6696 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6697 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6698 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6699 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6700 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006701
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006702http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6703http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6704 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6705 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6706 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6707 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006708
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006709 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6710 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6711 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006712 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006713 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6714 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6715 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006716 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006717 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006718
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006719http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6720 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6721 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6722 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6723
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006724http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6725 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006726
6727 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6728 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6729 pointed by <resolvers>.
6730 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6731 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6732 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6733 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6734 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6735 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6736 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6737 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6738 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6739 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006740 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6741 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006742
6743 Example:
6744 resolvers mydns
6745 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6746 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6747 timeout retry 1s
6748 hold valid 10s
6749 hold nx 3s
6750 hold other 3s
6751 hold obsolete 0s
6752 accepted_payload_size 8192
6753
6754 frontend fe
6755 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006756 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006757 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6758
6759 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6760 # which mean DNS resolution error
6761 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6762
6763 default_backend be
6764
6765 backend b_503
6766 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6767 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6768 # 503 error page to end users
6769
6770 backend be
6771 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6772 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6773 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6774 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6775 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6776
6777 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6778 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6779
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006780http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6781
6782 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6783 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6784 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6785 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006786 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6787 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006788
6789 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6790
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006791http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006792http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006793http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006794http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006795http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006796http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006797http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006798http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6799http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006800
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006801 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6802
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006803 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006804 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6805 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6806 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6807 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006808
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006809 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6810 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6811 the supported backend.
6812
6813 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6814 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6815 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6816 number of segments in the path.
6817
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006818 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6819 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6820 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6821 when improperly combined.
6822
6823 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6824 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6825 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6826 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6827 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6828
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006829 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006830
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006831 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6832
6833 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6834 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6835
6836 Example:
6837 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6838
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006839 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6840
6841 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6842 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6843
6844 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6845 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6846
6847 Example:
6848 - /#foo -> /
6849
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006850 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6851 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006852
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006853 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6854 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6855
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006856 Example:
6857 - /. -> /
6858 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6859 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6860 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006861
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006862 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6863 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6864
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006865 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006866 their preceding segment.
6867
6868 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6869 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6870
6871 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6872 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006873
6874 Example:
6875 - /foo/../ -> /
6876 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6877 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6878 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006879 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006880 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006881 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006882
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006883 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6884 removed as well:
6885
6886 Example:
6887 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6888 - /bar/../../ -> /
6889
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006890 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6891 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006892
6893 Example:
6894 - // -> /
6895 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6896
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006897 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6898 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6899
6900 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6901 ".", "_", and "~".
6902
6903 Example:
6904 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6905 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6906 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6907 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6908
6909 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6910 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6911
6912 Example:
6913 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6914 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6915
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006916 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006917 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006918
6919 Example:
6920 - /%6f -> /%6F
6921 - /%zz -> /%zz
6922
6923 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6924 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6925
6926 Example:
6927 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6928
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006929 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006930 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6931 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6932
6933 Example:
6934 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6935 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6936 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6937
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006938http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6941 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6942 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6943 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6944 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006945
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006946http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006947
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006948 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6949 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6950 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6951 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006952
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006953http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6954 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006955
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006956 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006957 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6958 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6959 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6960 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6961 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006962
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006963 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6964 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6965 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6966 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6967 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006968
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006969 Example:
6970 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6971
6972 # applied to:
6973 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6974
6975 # outputs:
6976 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6977
6978 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006979
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006980 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6981
6982 # applied to:
6983 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006984
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006985 # outputs:
6986 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006987
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006988http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6989 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6990
6991 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6992 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006993 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6994 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6995 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006996
6997 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6998 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6999 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7000
7001 Example:
7002 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7003 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7004
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007005 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7006 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7007 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7008 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7009
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007010http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7011 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7012
7013 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7014 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7015 query-string are replaced.
7016
7017 Example:
7018 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7019 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7020
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007021http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7023
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007024 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7025 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7026 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7027 against.
7028
7029 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7030 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7031 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007032
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007033 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7034 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7035 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7036 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7037 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7038 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7039 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7040 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7041 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007042 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7043 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007044
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007045 Example:
7046 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7047 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007048
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007049 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7050 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007052http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7053 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007054
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007055 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7056 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7057 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7058 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007059
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007060 Example:
7061 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007062
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007063 # applied to:
7064 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007065
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007066 # outputs:
7067 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007068
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007069http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7070 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7071 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007072 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007073 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7074
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007075 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007076 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7077 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007078 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007079 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007080 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007081 are followed to create the response :
7082
7083 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7084 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7085 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7086 ignored.
7087
7088 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7089 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007090 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007091 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7092 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007093
7094 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7095 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7096 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007097 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007098 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007099
7100 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7101 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7102 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007103 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007104 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007105 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007106
7107 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7108 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7109 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7110 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7111 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7112 as a raw content.
7113
7114 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7115 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7116 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7117 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7118 considered as a raw string.
7119
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007120 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007121 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7122 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7123 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7124
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007125 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7126 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007127 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007128
7129 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7130
7131 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007132 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007133 if { path /ping }
7134
7135 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7136 if { path /favicon.ico }
7137
7138 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7139 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7140 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7141
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007142http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7143
7144 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7145 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7146 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7147 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7148 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7149 at this index.
7150 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7151 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007153http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7154http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007156 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7157 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7158 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007159
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007160http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7161 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7162 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7163 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7164 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7165 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7166 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7167 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7168 at this index.
7169 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7170 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7171
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007172http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007174
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007175 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7176 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7177 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7178 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007179
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007180http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7181 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7182
7183 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7184 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7185 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7186 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7187 agent name must be used.
7188
7189 Arguments:
7190 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7191
7192 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7193 configuration.
7194
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007195http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7196
7197 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7198 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7199 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7200 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7201 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7202 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7203 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7204 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7205
7206 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7207 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7208 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7209
7210 Arguments:
7211 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7212 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7213 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7214 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7215
7216 Example:
7217 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7218 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7219
7220 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7221
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007222http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007223
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007224 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7225 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7226 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7227 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7228 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007230 Arguments:
7231 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7232 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007234 Example:
7235 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7236 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007238 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7239 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007241http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007243 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7244 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7245 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007247 Arguments:
7248 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7249 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007251 Example:
7252 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7253 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007255 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7256 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7257 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007259http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007261 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7262 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7263 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7264 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7265 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007267 Example:
7268 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7269 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7270 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7271 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7272 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7273 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7274 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7275 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7276 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007278http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007280 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7281 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7282 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7283 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7284 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007286http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7287 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007289 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7290 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7291 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7292 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7293 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7294 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7295 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7296 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7297 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007299http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007300
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007301 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7302 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7303 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7304 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7305 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7306 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7307 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007308 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7309 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007311http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007313 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7314 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7315 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007317http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007319 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7320 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7321 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7322 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7323 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7324 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7325 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7326 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007328http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007330 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7331 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7332 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7333 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7334 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7335 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007337 Example :
7338 # prepend the host name before the path
7339 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007340
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007341http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7342
7343 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7344 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7345 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007347http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007349 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7350 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7351 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7352 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7353 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007355http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007357 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7358 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7359 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7360 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7361 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7362 values have higher priority.
7363 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7364 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7365 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7366 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7367 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007369http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007371 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7372 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7373 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7374 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7375 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7376 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7377 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007378
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007379 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007380
7381 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007382 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7383 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007385http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7386 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7387 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7388 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007389 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7390 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007391
7392 Arguments :
7393 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7394 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007395
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007396 See also "option forwardfor".
7397
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007398 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007399 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7400 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7401
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007402 # After the masking this will track connections
7403 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7404 http-request track-sc0 src
7405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007406 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7407 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7408
7409http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7410
7411 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7412 expression.
7413
7414 Arguments:
7415 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7416 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007417
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007418 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007419 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7420 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7421
7422 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7423 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7424 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7425
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007426http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007427 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7428
7429 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7430 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7431 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7432 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7433 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7434
7435 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7436 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7437 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7438 results.
7439
7440 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007441 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7442 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007444http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7445
7446 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7447 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7448 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7449 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7450 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7451 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7452 information from the request.
7453
7454 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7455
7456http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7457
7458 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7459 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007460 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7461 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7462 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7463 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7464 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007465 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7466
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007467http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7468http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007469
7470 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7471 inline.
7472
7473 Arguments:
7474 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7475 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7476 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7477 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7478 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7479 (request and response)
7480 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7481 processing
7482 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7483 processing
7484 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7485 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7486 and '_'.
7487
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007488 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7489 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007490 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007491 conditions.
7492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007493 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7494 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007495
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007496 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7497 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7498
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007499 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007500 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007501 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7502
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007503http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007504
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7506 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7507 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7508 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7509 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7510
7511 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7512 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7513 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7514 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7515 session tables.
7516
7517 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7518 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7519 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7520 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7521 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7522 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7523 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007524
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007525http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007526
7527 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7528 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7529 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7530 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7531 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007532 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007533 processing.
7534
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007535 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007536 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7537 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7538 rules evaluation.
7539
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007540http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7541http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7542 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7543 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7544 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007546
7547 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7548 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7549 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007550 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7551 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7552 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7553 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7554 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7555 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007556 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007557 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7558 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7559 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007560 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007561 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7562 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7563 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7564 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7565 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007566
7567http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7568http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7569http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7570
7571 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7572 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7573 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7574 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007575 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007576 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7577 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7578 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7579 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7580 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7581 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7582 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7583
7584 Arguments :
7585 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7586 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7587 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7588 select which table entry to update the counters.
7589
7590 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7591 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7592 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7593 that table until the session ends.
7594
7595 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7596 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7597 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7598 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7599 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7600 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7601 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7602 useful information.
7603
7604 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7605 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7606 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7607 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7608 checks that make use of it.
7609
7610http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7611
7612 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007613
7614 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007615 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007616
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007617http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7618
7619 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7620 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7621 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7622 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7623 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7624 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7625
7626 Arguments :
7627 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7628
7629 Example:
7630 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7631
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007632http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7633 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7634
7635 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7636 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7637 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7638 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7639 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7640 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7641 http-buffer-request".
7642
7643 Arguments :
7644
7645 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7646 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7647
7648 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007649 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007650 bytes.
7651
7652 Example:
7653 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7654
7655 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007657http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007659 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7660 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7661 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007662
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007664http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007665 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7666
7667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007668 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007669
7670 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7671 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7672 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7673 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7674 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7675 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7676
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007677 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7678 supported:
7679 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7680 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7681 - allow
7682 - cache-store <name>
7683 - capture <sample> id <id>
7684 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7685 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7686 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7687 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7688 - redirect <rule>
7689 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7690 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7691 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7692 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7693 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7694 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7695 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7696 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7697 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007698 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007699 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7700 - set-log-level <level>
7701 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7702 - set-mark <mark>
7703 - set-nice <nice>
7704 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7705 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007706 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7707 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007708 - silent-drop
7709 - strict-mode { on | off }
7710 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7711 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7712 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7713 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7714 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7715
7716 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007718 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007719
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007720 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7721 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7722 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7723 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7724 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7725 a defaults section defining such rules.
7726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007727 Example:
7728 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007730 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007731
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007732 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7733 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007735 Example:
7736 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007738 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007739
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007740 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7741 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007743 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7744 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007746http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007747
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007748 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7749 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007750
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007751http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007752
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007753 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007754 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7755 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007757http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007759 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7760 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007761
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007762http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007763
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007764 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007766http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007768 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7769 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7770 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7771 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7772 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7773 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7774 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007776 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7777 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7778 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7779 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7780 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007781
7782 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7783 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7784 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7785 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007787http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007788
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007789 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7790 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007791
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007792http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007793
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007794 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7795 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007797http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007798
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007799 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7800 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007801
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007802http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7803http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7804 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7805 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7806 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7807 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007808
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007809 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7810 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7811 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007812 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007813 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7814 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7815 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007816 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007817 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007819http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007820
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007821 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7822 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7823 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7824 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7825 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7826 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007828http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7829 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007830
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007831 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7832 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007834 Example:
7835 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007836
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007837 # applied to:
7838 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007840 # outputs:
7841 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007843 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007845http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7846 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007847
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007848 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007849 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007851 Example:
7852 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007854 # applied to:
7855 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007857 # outputs:
7858 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007859
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007860http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7861 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7862 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007863 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007864 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7865
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007866 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7867 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7868 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007869
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007870http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007871http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7872http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007873
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007874 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7875 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7876 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7877 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007878
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007879http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007880 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007881http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7882 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007883http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007885
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007886 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7887 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7888 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007889
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007890http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7891 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007892
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007893 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7894 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007895
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007896http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7897
7898 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7899 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
7900 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
7901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007902http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007903
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007904 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7905 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7906 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7907 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007909http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7910
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007911 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7912 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007913
7914http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7915
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007916 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7917 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007918
7919http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7920
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007921 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7922 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7923 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007924
7925http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007927 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7928 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007929
7930http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7932
7933 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7934 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7935 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7936 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007937
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007938 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007939 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7940 http-response set-status 431
7941 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7942 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007944http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007946 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007947 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7948 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007949
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007950http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7951http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007952
7953 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007954 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7955 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007956
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007957http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007958
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007959 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7960 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007961 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7962 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007963
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007964http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007965
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007966 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7967 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007968
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007969http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7970http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7971http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007972
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007973 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7974 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7975 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007976
7977http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7978
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007979 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007980 about <var-name>.
7981
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007982http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7983 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7984
7985 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007986 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7987 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007988
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007989
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007990http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7991 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7992
7993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7994 yes | no | yes | yes
7995
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007996 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007997 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7998 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7999 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008000
8001 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8002
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008003 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8004 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8005 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8006 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8007 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8008 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8009 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008010 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008011 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8012 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008013
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008014 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8015 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8016 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8017 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8018 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8019 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8020 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008021 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8022 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8023 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8024 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8025 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8026 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008027
8028 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8029 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8030 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8031 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8032 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8033 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8034 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8035 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008036 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008037 downsides of rare connection failures.
8038
8039 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8040 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8041 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8042 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8043 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8044 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008045 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008046 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8047 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8048 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8049 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8050 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8051
8052 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008053 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8054 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8055 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8056 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008057
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008058 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8059 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008060
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008061 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008062
8063 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8064 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8065 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8066
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008067 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8068 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8069 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8070 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8071 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8072 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8073 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8074 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8075 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8076 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8077 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8078
8079 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8080 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8081 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8082 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8083 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8084
8085 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8086 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008087
8088
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008089http-send-name-header [<header>]
8090 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008091 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8092 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008093 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008094 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8095
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008096 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8097 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8098 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8099 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8100 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8101 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8102 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8103 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8104 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8105 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8106 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8107 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8108 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8109 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8110 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8111 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008112
8113 See also : "server"
8114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008115id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008116 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 no | yes | yes | yes
8119 Arguments : none
8120
8121 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8122 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8123 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008124
8125
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008126ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8127 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8128 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008129 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008130
8131 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8132 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8133 and running).
8134
8135 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8136 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8137 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008138 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008139 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8140
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008141 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8142 "unless" condition is met.
8143
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008144 Example:
8145 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8146 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8147 ignore-persist if url_static
8148
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008149 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8150
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008151load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8152 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8153 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8154 yes | no | yes | yes
8155
8156 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8157 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8158 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008159 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008160 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008161 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8162 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8163 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8164
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008165 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008166 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008167 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008168
8169 Arguments:
8170 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8171 named "server-state-file".
8172
8173 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8174 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8175 name is used as a file name.
8176
8177 none don't load any stat for this backend
8178
8179 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008180 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8181 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8182 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008183 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008184 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008185
8186 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8187 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8188
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008189 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008190
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008191 global
8192 stats socket /tmp/socket
8193 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008195 defaults
8196 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008197
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008198 backend bk
8199 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8200 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008201
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008202
8203 Then one can run :
8204
8205 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8206
8207 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8208
8209 1
8210 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8211 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8212 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8213
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008214 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008215
8216 global
8217 stats socket /tmp/socket
8218 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8219
8220 defaults
8221 load-server-state-from-file local
8222
8223 backend bk
8224 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8225 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8226
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008227
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008228 Then one can run :
8229
8230 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8231
8232 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8233
8234 1
8235 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8236 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8237 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8238
8239 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8240 "show servers state"
8241
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008243log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008244log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008245 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008246no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008247 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8249 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008250
8251 Prefix :
8252 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8253 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8254 prefix does not allow arguments.
8255
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008256 Arguments :
8257 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8258 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8259 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8260 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8261 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8262 parameter.
8263
8264 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8265 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8266
8267 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8268 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8269 standard syslog port).
8270
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008271 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8272 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8273 standard syslog port).
8274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008275 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8276 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8277 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008278 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008279
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008280 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8281 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8282 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8283 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8284 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8285 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8286 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8287 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8288 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8289 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8290 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8291 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008292 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008293 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8294 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8295 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008296 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8297 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008298
8299 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8300 and "fd@2", see above.
8301
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008302 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8303 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8304 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8305 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8306 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8307 having the logs instantly available.
8308
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008309 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8310 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8311 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8312
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008313 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8314 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008315
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008316 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8317 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8318 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8319 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8320 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8321 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8322 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8323 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8324 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8325 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008326 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008327
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008328 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8329 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8330 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8331 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8332 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8333
8334 <sample_size>
8335 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8336 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8337 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8338 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8339 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8340
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008341 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8342 one of the following :
8343
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008344 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8345 field is stripped. This is the default.
8346 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8347 rfc3164.
8348
8349 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008350 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8351
8352 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8353 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8354
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008355 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8356 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8357 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8358 designed to be used with a local log server.
8359
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008360 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8361 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8362 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8363 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8364 systemd logger consumes.
8365
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008366 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8367 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8368 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8369 used with a local log server.
8370
8371 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8372 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8373 designed to be used with a local log server.
8374
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008375 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8376 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8377 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8378 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8379
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008380 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8381
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008382 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8383 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8384 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8385
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008386 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8387 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8388 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8389 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008390
8391 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8392 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8393 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008394 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8395 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8396 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8397 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8398 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008399
8400 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8401
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008402 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8403 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8404 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008405
8406 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8407 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8408 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8409 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8410
8411 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8412 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008413
8414 Example :
8415 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008416 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8417 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8418 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008419 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008420 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8421 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008422 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008423
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008424
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008425log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008426 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8427 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8428 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008429
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008430 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8431 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8432 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8433 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8434 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008435 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8436 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008437
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008438 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8439 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008440
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008441log-format-sd <string>
8442 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8443 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8444 yes | yes | yes | no
8445
8446 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8447 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8448 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8449 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8450 which covers the log format string in depth.
8451
8452 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8453 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8454
8455 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8456 log format to "rfc5424".
8457
8458 Example :
8459 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8460
8461
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008462log-tag <string>
8463 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 yes | yes | yes | yes
8466
8467 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8468 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008469 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008470 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8471 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8472 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8473 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8474 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8475 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008476
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008477max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8478 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8480 yes | no | yes | yes
8481
8482 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8483 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8484 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8485 servers.
8486
8487 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008488 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008489 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8490 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8491 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008492 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008493 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8494 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8495 picking a different server.
8496
8497 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8498 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8499 even if they have to be queued.
8500
8501 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8502 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8503
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008504max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8505 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8506 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8507 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008508
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008509maxconn <conns>
8510 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8512 yes | yes | yes | no
8513 Arguments :
8514 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8515 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8516 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8517 closes.
8518
8519 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008520 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008521 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8522 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008523 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8524 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8525 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8526 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008527
8528 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8529 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8530 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8531
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008532 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8533 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008534
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008535 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8536
8537
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008538mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008539 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8541 yes | yes | yes | yes
8542 Arguments :
8543 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8544 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8545 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8546 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8547
8548 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8549 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8550 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8551 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8552 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8553
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008554 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8555 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8556 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008557
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008558 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008559 defaults http_instances
8560 mode http
8561
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008562
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008563monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008564 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8566 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008567 Arguments :
8568 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8569 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008570 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008571 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8572 backend and its backup.
8573
8574 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8575 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8576 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8577 servers in a list of backends.
8578
8579 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8580 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8581 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008582 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008583 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8584 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008585 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008586 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8587 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008588
8589 Example:
8590 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008591 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008592 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8593 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8594 monitor-uri /site_alive
8595 monitor fail if site_dead
8596
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008597 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008598
8599
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008600monitor-uri <uri>
8601 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8603 yes | yes | yes | no
8604 Arguments :
8605 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8606 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8607
8608 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8609 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8610 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8611 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8612 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8613 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8614 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8615 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8616
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008617 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008618 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8619 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008620 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8621 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8622 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008623 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8624 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8625 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008626
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008627 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8628 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8629 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8630 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8631
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008632 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008633 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008634 frontend www
8635 mode http
8636 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8637
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008638 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008640
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008641option abortonclose
8642no option abortonclose
8643 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8645 yes | no | yes | yes
8646 Arguments : none
8647
8648 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8649 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8650 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8651 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008652 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008653 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8654 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8655 encountered while delivering the response.
8656
8657 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8658 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8659 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8660 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8661 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8662 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008664 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008665 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008666 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8667 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8668 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8669
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008670 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8671 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008672 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8673 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8674 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8675 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8676 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8677 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008678 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008679
8680 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8681 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8682
8683 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8684
8685
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008686option accept-invalid-http-request
8687no option accept-invalid-http-request
8688 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8690 yes | yes | yes | no
8691 Arguments : none
8692
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008693 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008694 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008695 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008696 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8697 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8698 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8699 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8700 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008701 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8702 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8703 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8704 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008705 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008706 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008707 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008708 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8709 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008710
8711 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8712 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8713 been confirmed.
8714
8715 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8716 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008717 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8718 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008719 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8720
8721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8723
8724 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8725 stats socket.
8726
8727
8728option accept-invalid-http-response
8729no option accept-invalid-http-response
8730 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8732 yes | no | yes | yes
8733 Arguments : none
8734
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008735 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008736 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008737 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008738 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8739 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8740 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8741 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8742 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008743 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8744 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8745 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008746
8747 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8748 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8749 been confirmed.
8750
8751 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8752 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8753 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8754 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8755
8756 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8757 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8758
8759 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8760 stats socket.
8761
8762
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008763option allbackups
8764no option allbackups
8765 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8767 yes | no | yes | yes
8768 Arguments : none
8769
8770 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8771 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8772 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8773 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8774 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8775 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8776 order between the backup servers anymore.
8777
8778 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8779 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8780
8781 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8782 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8783
8784
8785option checkcache
8786no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008787 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8789 yes | no | yes | yes
8790 Arguments : none
8791
8792 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8793 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008794 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008795 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8796 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008797 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008798
8799 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008800 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008801 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008802 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8803 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008804 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008805 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008806 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8807 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008808 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008809 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8810 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008811 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008812 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8813 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8814 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8815 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8816 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8817 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8818 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8819 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8820 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8821
8822 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008823 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8824 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8825 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8826 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008827
8828 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8829 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008830 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008832
8833 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8834 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8835
8836
8837option clitcpka
8838no option clitcpka
8839 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8841 yes | yes | yes | no
8842 Arguments : none
8843
8844 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8845 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008846 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008847 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8848
8849 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8850 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8851 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8852 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8853
8854 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8855 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8856 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8857 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8858 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8859
8860 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8861
8862 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8863 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8864 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8865
8866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8868
8869 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8870
8871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008872option contstats
8873 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8875 yes | yes | yes | no
8876 Arguments : none
8877
8878 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8879 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8880 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008881 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008882 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8883 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8884 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8885 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8886 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008887
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008888option disable-h2-upgrade
8889no option disable-h2-upgrade
8890 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8891 connection.
8892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8893 yes | yes | yes | no
8894 Arguments : none
8895
8896 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8897 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8898 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8899 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008900 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8901 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8902 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8903 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8904 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8905 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008906
8907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008909
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008910option dontlog-normal
8911no option dontlog-normal
8912 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8914 yes | yes | yes | no
8915 Arguments : none
8916
8917 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8918 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8919 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8920 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8921 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8922 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8923 logged.
8924
8925 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8926 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8927 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008929 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008930 logging.
8931
8932
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008933option dontlognull
8934no option dontlognull
8935 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8937 yes | yes | yes | no
8938 Arguments : none
8939
8940 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8941 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8942 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8943 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8944 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8945 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008946 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8947 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8948 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008949
8950 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008951 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008952 would not be logged.
8953
8954 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8955 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8956
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008957 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008958 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008959
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008960
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008961option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008962 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 yes | yes | yes | yes
8965 Arguments :
8966 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8967 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008968 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008969 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008970
8971 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8972 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8973 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8974 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8975 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8976 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8977 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008978 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8979 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8980 possible that the client has already brought one.
8981
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008982 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008983 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008984 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008985 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008986 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008987 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008988
8989 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8990 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8991 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8992 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8993 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8994 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008995 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008996
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008997 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8998 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008999 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009000 are under the control of the end-user.
9001
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009002 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009003 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9004 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009005 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9006 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9007 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009008
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009009 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009010 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9011 frontend www
9012 mode http
9013 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9014
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009015 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9016 backend www
9017 mode http
9018 option forwardfor header X-Client
9019
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009020 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009021 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009022
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009023
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009024option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9025no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9026 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9028 yes | yes | yes | no
9029 Arguments : none
9030
9031 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9032 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9033 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9034 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9035 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9036 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9037 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9038
9039 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9040 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9041 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9042 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9043 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9044 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9045 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9046 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9047 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9048 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9049
9050 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9051
9052 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9053 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9054
9055 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9056 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9057
9058
9059option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9060no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9061 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | no | yes | yes
9064 Arguments : none
9065
9066 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9067 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9068 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9069 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9070 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9071 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9072 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9073
9074 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9075 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9076 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9077 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9078 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9079 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9080 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9081 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9082 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9083 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9084
9085 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9086
9087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9089
9090 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9091 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9092
9093
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009094option http-buffer-request
9095no option http-buffer-request
9096 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9098 yes | yes | yes | yes
9099 Arguments : none
9100
9101 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9102 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9103 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9104 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9105 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9106 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009107 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9108 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9109 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9110 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009111
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009112 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9113 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009114
9115
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009116option http-ignore-probes
9117no option http-ignore-probes
9118 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9120 yes | yes | yes | no
9121 Arguments : none
9122
9123 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9124 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9125 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9126 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9127 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9128 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9129 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9130 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9131 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009132 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9133 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009134 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9135
9136 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9137 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9138 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9139 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9140 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9141 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9142 are often the only way to detect them.
9143
9144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9146
9147 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9148
9149
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009150option http-keep-alive
9151no option http-keep-alive
9152 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
9153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9154 yes | yes | yes | yes
9155 Arguments : none
9156
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009157 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9158 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009159 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9160 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009161 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
9162 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
9163 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009164
9165 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9166 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009167 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9168 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9169 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9170 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9171 situations where this option may be useful :
9172
9173 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009175
9176 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9177 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9178
9179 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
9180 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
9181 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
9182 request.
9183
9184 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
9185 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009186 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
9187 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
9188 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009189
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009190 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9191 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9192 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9193 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9194 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9195 not set.
9196
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009197 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9198 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
9199 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009200
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009201 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009202 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01009203 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009204
9205
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009206option http-no-delay
9207no option http-no-delay
9208 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | yes | yes | yes
9211 Arguments : none
9212
9213 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9214 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9215 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9216 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9217 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9218 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9219 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009220 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009221 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9222 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9223 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9224 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9225 affected.
9226
9227 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9228 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9229 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9230 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9231 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9232 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9233 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9234 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9235 latency environments.
9236
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009237 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9238
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009239
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009240option http-pretend-keepalive
9241no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009242 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009244 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009245 Arguments : none
9246
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009247 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009248 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
9249 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
9250 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009251 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009252 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
9253 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
9254 consider the response complete.
9255
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009256 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009257 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009258 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009259 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009260 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009261 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9262
9263 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9264 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9265 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9266 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009267 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9268 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009269 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9270
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009271 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9272 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9273 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
9274 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
9275 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
9276 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009277
9278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9280
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009281 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009282 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009283
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009284option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9285 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9286 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9288 yes | yes | yes | yes
9289 Arguments :
9290 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9291 with no FastCGI application configured.
9292
9293 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9294 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9295 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9296
9297 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9298 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9299
9300 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9301 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9302 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9303 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9304 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9305 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9306 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9307 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9308
9309 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9310 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009311
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009312option http-server-close
9313no option http-server-close
9314 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
9315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9316 yes | yes | yes | yes
9317 Arguments : none
9318
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009319 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9320 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9321 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9322 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009323 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
9324 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
9325 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
9326 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
9327 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
9328 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
9329 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
9330 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
9331 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
9332 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
9333 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009334
9335 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9336 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9337 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9338 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009339 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9340 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009341
9342 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9343 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009344 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9345 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9346 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009347
9348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9350
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009351 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
9352 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009353
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009354option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009355no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009356 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9358 yes | yes | yes | no
9359 Arguments : none
9360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009361 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009362 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9363 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9364 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9365 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9366 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009367 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009368
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009369 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009370 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009371 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9372 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9373 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009374
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009375 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9376 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9377 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9378 front of an existing proxy.
9379
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009380 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9381
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009382 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009383
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009384option httpchk
9385option httpchk <uri>
9386option httpchk <method> <uri>
9387option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009388 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 yes | no | yes | yes
9391 Arguments :
9392 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9393 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9394 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9395 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9396 ones.
9397
9398 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9399 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9400 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9401
9402 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9403 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9404 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009405 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009406
9407 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9408 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9409 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9410 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9411 the lack of any response.
9412
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009413 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9414 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9415 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9416 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9417
9418 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9419 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9420 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009421
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009422 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9423 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009424 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009425 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009426 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009427
9428 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009429 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9430 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9431 backend https_relay
9432 mode tcp
9433 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9434 http-check send hdr Host www
9435 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009436
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009437 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9438 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9439 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009440
9441
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009442option httpclose
9443no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009444 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9446 yes | yes | yes | yes
9447 Arguments : none
9448
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009449 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
9450 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
9451 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
9452 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009453 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009454
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009455 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
9456 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009457 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009458 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
9459 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009460
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009461 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
9462 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
9463 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009464
9465 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9466 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009467 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
9468 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9469 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009470
9471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9473
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009474 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009475
9476
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009477option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009478 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009480 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009481 Arguments :
9482 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9483 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9484 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009485 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009486 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009487
9488 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9489 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9490 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9491 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9492 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9493 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9494 ports.
9495
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009496 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9497 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009498
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009499 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009501 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009502
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009503option httpslog
9504 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9506 yes | yes | yes | no
9507
9508 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9509 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9510 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9511 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9512 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9513 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9514 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9515
9516 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9517
9518 See also : section 8 about logging.
9519
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009520
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009521option independent-streams
9522no option independent-streams
9523 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9525 yes | yes | yes | yes
9526 Arguments : none
9527
9528 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9529 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9530 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9531 receive data or not.
9532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009533 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009534 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9535 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9536 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9537 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9538 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9539 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9540 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9541 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9542 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9543 socket buffers.
9544
9545 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9546 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9547 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9548 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9549 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9550
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009551 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009552
9553
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009554option ldap-check
9555 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9557 yes | no | yes | yes
9558 Arguments : none
9559
9560 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9561 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9562 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9563 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9564
9565 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9566 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9567
9568 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9569 configure it.
9570
9571 Example :
9572 option ldap-check
9573
9574 See also : "option httpchk"
9575
9576
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009577option external-check
9578 Use external processes for server health checks
9579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9580 yes | no | yes | yes
9581
9582 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9583 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9584 command".
9585
9586 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9587
9588 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9589
9590
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009591option idle-close-on-response
9592no option idle-close-on-response
9593 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9595 yes | yes | yes | no
9596 Arguments : none
9597
9598 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9599 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9600 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9601 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9602 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9603 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9604 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9605 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9606 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9607
9608 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9609 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9610
9611 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9612 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9613 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9614 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9615
9616 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9617 "hard-stop-after"
9618
9619
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009620option log-health-checks
9621no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009622 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9624 yes | no | yes | yes
9625 Arguments : none
9626
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009627 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9628 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9629 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009630
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009631 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9632 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9633 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9634 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9635 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9636
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009637 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009638 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009639
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009640 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9641 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9642 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009643
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009644
9645option log-separate-errors
9646no option log-separate-errors
9647 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9649 yes | yes | yes | no
9650 Arguments : none
9651
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009652 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009653 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9654 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9655 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9656 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9657 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9658 provides very important information.
9659
9660 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9661 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9662 error logs.
9663
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009664 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009665 logging.
9666
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009667
9668option logasap
9669no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009670 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9672 yes | yes | yes | no
9673 Arguments : none
9674
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009675 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9676 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9677 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9678 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9679
9680 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9681 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9682 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9683 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9684 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009685 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009686 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9687 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9688 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9689 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009690 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009692 Examples :
9693 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9694 mode http
9695 option httplog
9696 option logasap
9697 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9698
9699 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9700 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9701 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9702 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009704 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009705 logging.
9706
9707
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009708option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009709 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9711 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009712 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009713 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9714 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009715 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9716 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009717
9718 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9719 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009720 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009721 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009722 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9723 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9724 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009725
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009726 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9727 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9728 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009729
9730 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009731 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009732 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9733 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9734 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9735 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9736 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9737 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9738 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9739
9740 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9741 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009742
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009743 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009744
9745 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9746 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9747 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9748 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009749 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009750 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009751
9752 See also: "option httpchk"
9753
9754
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009755option nolinger
9756no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009757 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9759 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009760 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009761
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009762 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009763 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9764 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9765 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9766 connections.
9767
9768 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9769 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009770 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9771 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9772 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9773 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9774 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9775 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9776 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9777 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9778 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9779 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9780 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9781 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9782 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009783
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009784 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9785 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9786 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9787 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9788 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009789
9790 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9791 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009792 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009793 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009794 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009795
9796 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9797 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9798
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009799 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9800 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009801
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009802option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9803 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9805 yes | yes | yes | yes
9806 Arguments :
9807 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9808 matching <network>
9809 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9810 header name.
9811
9812 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9813 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9814 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9815 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9816 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9817 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9818 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9819 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9820 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9821 possible that the client has already brought one.
9822
9823 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9824 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9825 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9826 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9827 header and requires different one.
9828
9829 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9830 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9831 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009832 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9833 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9834 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9835 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9836 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009837
9838 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9839 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9840 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9841 both are defined.
9842
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009843 Examples :
9844 # Original Destination address
9845 frontend www
9846 mode http
9847 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9848
9849 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9850 backend www
9851 mode http
9852 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9853
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009854 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009855
9856
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009857option persist
9858no option persist
9859 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9861 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009862 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009863
9864 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9865 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9866 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9867 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9868 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9869 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9870 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9871 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9872 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9873 redirected to another valid server.
9874
9875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9877
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009878 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009879
9880
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009881option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009882 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9884 yes | no | yes | yes
9885 Arguments :
9886 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9887 PostgreSQL server.
9888
9889 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9890 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9891 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9892 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9893
9894 See also: "option httpchk"
9895
9896
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009897option prefer-last-server
9898no option prefer-last-server
9899 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9901 yes | no | yes | yes
9902 Arguments : none
9903
9904 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009905 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009906 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9907 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009908 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009909 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009910 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009911 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9912 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009913 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009914 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009915 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9916 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9917 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009918 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9919 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9920 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009921
9922 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9923 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9924
9925 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9926
9927
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009928option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009929option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009930no option redispatch
9931 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9932 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9933 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009934 Arguments :
9935 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9936 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9937 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009938 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009939 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009940 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009941 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9942 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9943 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009945
9946 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9947 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9948 be able to access the service anymore.
9949
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009950 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9951 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009952
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009953 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9954 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9955 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9956 following order:
9957
9958 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9959
9960 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9961 list, or
9962
9963 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9964
9965 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9966 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9967
9968 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9969 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9970 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9971 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9972
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009973 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009974 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9975 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9979
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009980 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009981
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009982
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009983option redis-check
9984 Use redis health checks for server testing
9985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9986 yes | no | yes | yes
9987 Arguments : none
9988
9989 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9990 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9991 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9992 find the "+PONG" response message.
9993
9994 Example :
9995 option redis-check
9996
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009997 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009998
9999
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010000option smtpchk
10001option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10002 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10004 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010005 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010006 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010007 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010008 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10009
10010 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10011 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10012 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10013
10014 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10015 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10016 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10017 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10018 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10019 dead server.
10020
10021 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10022 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010023 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010024 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10025
10026 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10027 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10028 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10029 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010030 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010031
10032 Example :
10033 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10034
10035 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010038option socket-stats
10039no option socket-stats
10040
10041 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10043 yes | yes | yes | no
10044
10045 Arguments : none
10046
10047
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010048option splice-auto
10049no option splice-auto
10050 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10052 yes | yes | yes | yes
10053 Arguments : none
10054
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010055 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010056 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010057 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010058 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010059 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010060 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10061 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10062 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10063 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10064
10065 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10066 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10067 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10068 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10069 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10070 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10071 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10072 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10073 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10074 keyword.
10075
10076 Example :
10077 option splice-auto
10078
10079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10081
10082 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10083 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10084
10085
10086option splice-request
10087no option splice-request
10088 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10090 yes | yes | yes | yes
10091 Arguments : none
10092
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010093 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010094 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010095 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10096 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10097 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10098 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10099
10100 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10101
10102 Example :
10103 option splice-request
10104
10105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10107
10108 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10109 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10110
10111
10112option splice-response
10113no option splice-response
10114 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10116 yes | yes | yes | yes
10117 Arguments : none
10118
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010119 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010120 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010121 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10122 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10123 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10124 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10125
10126 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10127
10128 Example :
10129 option splice-response
10130
10131 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10132 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10133
10134 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10135 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10136
10137
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010138option spop-check
10139 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10141 no | no | no | yes
10142 Arguments : none
10143
10144 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10145 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10146 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10147 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10148
10149 Example :
10150 option spop-check
10151
10152 See also : "option httpchk"
10153
10154
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010155option srvtcpka
10156no option srvtcpka
10157 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10159 yes | no | yes | yes
10160 Arguments : none
10161
10162 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10163 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010164 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010165 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10166
10167 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10168 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10169 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10170 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10171
10172 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10173 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10174 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10175 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10176 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10177
10178 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10179
10180 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10181 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10182 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10183
10184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10186
10187 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10188
10189
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010190option ssl-hello-chk
10191 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10193 yes | no | yes | yes
10194 Arguments : none
10195
10196 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10197 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10198 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10199 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10200 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10201 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10202 hello message.
10203
10204 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10205 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10206 messages, which is appreciable.
10207
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010208 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010209 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10210 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010211
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010212 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10213
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010214
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010215option tcp-check
10216 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10218 yes | no | yes | yes
10219
10220 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10221 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10222
10223 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10224 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10225 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10226
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010227 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010228 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10229 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10230 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10231 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10232 only.
10233
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010234 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010235 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010236 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10237 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10238 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10239
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010240 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010241 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10242 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010243 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010244 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10245 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10246 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10247 the respective protocols.
10248 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010250
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010251 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010252
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010253 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10254 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10255 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10256 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010257
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010258 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10259 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10260 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010261
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010262
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010263 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010264 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010265 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010266 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010267
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010268 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010269 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010270 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010271
10272 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10273 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010274 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010275 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010276 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010277 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010278 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010279 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010280 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10281 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010282 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010283 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10284 tcp-check expect string +OK
10285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010286 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010287 (send many headers before analyzing)
10288 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010289 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010290 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10291 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10292 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10293 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010294 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010295
10296
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010297 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010298
10299
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010300option tcp-smart-accept
10301no option tcp-smart-accept
10302 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10304 yes | yes | yes | no
10305 Arguments : none
10306
10307 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10308 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10309 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10310 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10311 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10312 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10313
10314 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10315 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10316 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10317 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10318
10319 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10320 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10321 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010322 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010323
10324 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10325 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10326 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10327
10328 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10329 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10330 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10331
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010332 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10333
10334
10335option tcp-smart-connect
10336no option tcp-smart-connect
10337 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10339 yes | no | yes | yes
10340 Arguments : none
10341
10342 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10343 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10344 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10345 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10346 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10347
10348 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10349 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10350 complex.
10351
10352 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10353 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10354 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10355
10356 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10357 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10358
10359 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10360
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010361
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010362option tcpka
10363 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 yes | yes | yes | yes
10366 Arguments : none
10367
10368 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10369 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010370 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010371 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10372
10373 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10374 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10375 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10376 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10377
10378 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10379 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10380 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10381 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10382 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10383
10384 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10385
10386 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10387 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10388 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10389 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10390 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10391 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10392 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10393 backends.
10394
10395 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10396
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010397
10398option tcplog
10399 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010401 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010402 Arguments : none
10403
10404 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10405 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10406 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10407 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10408 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10409 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10410 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10411 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10412
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010413 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010415 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010416
10417
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010418option transparent
10419no option transparent
10420 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010422 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010423 Arguments : none
10424
10425 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10426 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10427 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10428 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10429 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10430 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10431 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10432 appropriate server.
10433
10434 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10435 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10436
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010437 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010438 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010439
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010440
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010441external-check command <command>
10442 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10444 yes | no | yes | yes
10445
10446 Arguments :
10447 <command> is the external command to run
10448
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010449 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10450
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010451 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010452
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010453 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10454 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10455 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10456 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10457 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10458 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010459
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010460 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10461
10462 Environment variables :
10463 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10464 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10465
10466 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10467
10468 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10469
10470 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10471 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10472 for a UNIX socket).
10473
10474 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10475
10476 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10477
10478 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10479
10480 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10481
10482 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10483
10484 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10485 socket).
10486
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010487 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10488
10489 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10490 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10491 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10492 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10493 TCP server).
10494
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010495 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10496 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10497
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010498 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10499
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010500 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10501 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10502 failed.
10503
10504 Example :
10505 external-check command /bin/true
10506
10507 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10508
10509
10510external-check path <path>
10511 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10513 yes | no | yes | yes
10514
10515 Arguments :
10516 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10517
10518 The default path is "".
10519
10520 Example :
10521 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10522
10523 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10524 "external-check command"
10525
10526
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010527persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010528persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010529 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10531 yes | no | yes | yes
10532 Arguments :
10533 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010534 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10535 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010536
10537 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10538 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010539 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010540 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10541 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10542 forwarded to this server.
10543
10544 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10545 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10546 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010547 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010548 a single "listen" section.
10549
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010550 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10551 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10552 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10553
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010554 Example :
10555 listen tse-farm
10556 bind :3389
10557 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10558 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10559 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10560 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10561 persist rdp-cookie
10562 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010563 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010564 balance rdp-cookie
10565 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10566 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10567
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010568 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010569
10570
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010571rate-limit sessions <rate>
10572 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10574 yes | yes | yes | no
10575 Arguments :
10576 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10577 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10578
10579 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10580 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10581 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010582 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010583 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10584 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10585
10586 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10587 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10588 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10589 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10590
10591 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10592 listen smtp
10593 mode tcp
10594 bind :25
10595 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010596 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010597
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010598 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10599 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10600 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010601
10602 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10603
10604
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010605redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10606redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10607redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010608 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10610 no | yes | yes | yes
10611
10612 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010613 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010614
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010615 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010616 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010617 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10618 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10619 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010620
10621 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10622 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10623 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10624 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10625 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010626 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10627 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10628 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10629 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010630
10631 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10632 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10633 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10634 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10635 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10636 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010637 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010638 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010639 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10640 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10641 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010642
10643 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010644 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10645 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10646 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010647 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010648 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10649 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10650 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10651 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010652
10653 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010654 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010655
10656 - "drop-query"
10657 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10658 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10659 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10660 with a location-type redirect.
10661
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010662 - "append-slash"
10663 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10664 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10665 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10666 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10667
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010668 - "ignore-empty"
10669 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10670 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10671 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10672 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10673 of known paths using a simple map.
10674
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010675 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10676 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10677 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10678 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10679 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10680 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10681 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10682
10683 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10684 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10685 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10686 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10687 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10688 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10689 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010690
10691 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10692 acl clear dst_port 80
10693 acl secure dst_port 8080
10694 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010695 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010696 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010697 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10698
10699 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010700 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10701 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10702 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010703 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010704
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010705 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10706 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10707 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010709 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010710 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010711
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010712 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010713 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10714 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10715 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010716
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010717 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10718 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10719 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010721 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010722
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010723
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010724retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010725 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10727 yes | no | yes | yes
10728 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010729 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10730 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010731
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010732 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10733 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10734 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10735 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10736 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010737
10738 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010739 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010740 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010741
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010742 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10743 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10744 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010745
10746 See also : "option redispatch"
10747
10748
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010749retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010750 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10751 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10752 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010753 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10754 yes | no | yes | yes
10755 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010756 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10757 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10758 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10759 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10760 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010761
10762 none never retry
10763
10764 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10765 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10766
10767 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10768 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10769 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10770 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10771 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10772 processing the request.
10773
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010774 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10775 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10776 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10777 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10778 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10779 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10780 overflow attack for example).
10781
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010782 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10783 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10784 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10785 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10786 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10787 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10788 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10789 amplify denial of service attacks.
10790
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010791 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10792 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10793 considered to be safe to retry.
10794
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010795 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10796 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10797 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10798 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10799 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010800
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010801 all-retryable-errors
10802 retry request for any error that are considered
10803 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10804 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10805 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10806
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010807 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10808 not cumulative.
10809
10810 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10811 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10812 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10813 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10814
10815 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10816 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10817 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10818 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10819 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10820 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10821 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10822 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10823 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10824 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10825 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10826 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10827
10828 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10829 should not use this directive.
10830
10831 The default is "conn-failure".
10832
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010833 Example:
10834 retry-on 503 504
10835
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010836 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10837
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010838server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010839 Declare a server in a backend
10840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10841 no | no | yes | yes
10842 Arguments :
10843 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010845 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010846
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010847 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10848 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10849 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10850 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010851 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10852 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010853 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010854 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10855 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010856 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10857 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10858 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10859 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10860 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10861 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10862 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010863 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010864 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10865 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10866 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10867 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10868 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10869 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010870 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10871 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010872 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10873 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010874
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010875 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010876 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10877 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10878 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10879 adding this value to the client's port.
10880
10881 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10882 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010883 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010884
10885 Examples :
10886 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10887 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010888 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010889 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10890 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10891 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010892
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010893 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10894 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10895 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10896 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10897 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10898
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010899 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10900 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010901
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010902server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010903 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010904 this backend.
10905 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10906 no | no | yes | yes
10907
10908 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10909 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10910 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10911 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10912 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010913
10914 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10915 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10916
10917 global
10918 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10919
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010920 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010921 load-server-state-from-file
10922
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010923 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010924 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010925
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010926server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10927 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10928 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10930 no | no | yes | yes
10931
10932 Arguments:
10933 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10934
10935 <num | range>
10936 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10937 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10938 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10939 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10940
10941 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10942
10943 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10944
10945 <params*>
10946 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10947 keyword.
10948
10949 Examples:
10950 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10951 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10952 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10953
10954 # or
10955 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10956
10957 # would be equivalent to:
10958 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10959 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10960 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10961
10962
10963
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010964source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010965source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010966source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010967 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10969 yes | no | yes | yes
10970 Arguments :
10971 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10972 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010973
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010974 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010975 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10976 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10977 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10978 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10979 supported prefixes are :
10980 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10981 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10982 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010983 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010984 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10985 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010986
10987 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10988 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010989 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10990 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10991 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010992
10993 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10994 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10995 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10996 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10997 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10998 <addr>.
10999
11000 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11001 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11002 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11003 port.
11004
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011005 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11006 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11007 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11008 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011009 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011010 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11011 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11012 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11013 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11014 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11015 HTTP header.
11016
11017 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11018 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011019 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011020 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11021 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11022 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11023 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11024 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11025 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11026 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11027
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011028 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11029 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11030 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11031 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11032 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11033 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11034
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011035 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11036 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11037 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11038 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11039
11040 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11041 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11042 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11043 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11044 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11045 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11046
11047 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11048 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11049 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11050 there are two methods :
11051
11052 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11053 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11054 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11055 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11056 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11057 of the client ranges may be used.
11058
11059 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11060 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11061 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11062 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11063 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11064 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11065 same session.
11066
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011067 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11068 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11069 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011070 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011071
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011072 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11073
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011074 Examples :
11075 backend private
11076 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11077 source 192.168.1.200
11078
11079 backend transparent_ssl1
11080 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11081 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11082
11083 backend transparent_ssl2
11084 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11085 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11086 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11087
11088 backend transparent_ssl3
11089 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11090 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11091 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11092
11093 backend transparent_smtp
11094 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11095 # with Tproxy version 4.
11096 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11097
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011098 backend transparent_http
11099 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11100 # proxy.
11101 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011103 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011104 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11105
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011106
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011107srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11108 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11109 the connection on the server side.
11110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11111 yes | no | yes | yes
11112 Arguments :
11113 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11114
11115 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11116 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011117 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11118 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011119
11120 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11121
11122
11123srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11124 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11125 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11126 server side.
11127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11128 yes | no | yes | yes
11129 Arguments :
11130 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11131 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11132 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11133 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11134
11135 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11136 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011137 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11138 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011139
11140 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11141
11142
11143srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11144 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11146 yes | no | yes | yes
11147 Arguments :
11148 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11149 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11150 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11151 document.
11152
11153 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11154 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011155 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11156 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011157
11158 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11159
11160
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011161stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11162 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011164 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011165
11166 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11167 matched.
11168
11169 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11170 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11171
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011172 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11173 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11174 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11175 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011176
11177 Example :
11178 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11179 backend stats_localhost
11180 stats enable
11181 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11182
11183 Example :
11184 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11185 backend stats_auth
11186 stats enable
11187 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11188 stats admin if TRUE
11189
11190 Example :
11191 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11192 userlist stats-auth
11193 group admin users admin
11194 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11195 group readonly users haproxy
11196 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11197
11198 backend stats_auth
11199 stats enable
11200 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11201 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11202 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11203 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11204
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011205 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11206 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011207
11208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011209stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11210 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011212 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011213 Arguments :
11214 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11215
11216 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11217
11218 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11219 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11220 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11221 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11222 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11223 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11224
11225 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11226 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11227 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011228 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011229
11230 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11231 report using "stats scope".
11232
11233 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11234 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11235 unobvious parameters.
11236
11237 Example :
11238 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11239 backend public_www
11240 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11241 stats enable
11242 stats hide-version
11243 stats scope .
11244 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011245 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011246 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11247 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11248
11249 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11250 backend private_monitoring
11251 stats enable
11252 stats uri /admin?stats
11253 stats refresh 5s
11254
11255 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11256
11257
11258stats enable
11259 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011262 Arguments : none
11263
11264 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11265 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11266 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11267 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11268 - stats auth : no authentication
11269 - stats scope : no restriction
11270
11271 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11272 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11273 unobvious parameters.
11274
11275 Example :
11276 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11277 backend public_www
11278 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11279 stats enable
11280 stats hide-version
11281 stats scope .
11282 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011283 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011284 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11285 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11286
11287 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11288 backend private_monitoring
11289 stats enable
11290 stats uri /admin?stats
11291 stats refresh 5s
11292
11293 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11294
11295
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011296stats hide-version
11297 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011299 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011300 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011301
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011302 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11303 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11304 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11305 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11306 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11307 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011309 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11310 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11311 unobvious parameters.
11312
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011313 Example :
11314 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11315 backend public_www
11316 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011317 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011318 stats hide-version
11319 stats scope .
11320 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011321 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011322 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11323 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011324
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011325 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11326 backend private_monitoring
11327 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011328 stats uri /admin?stats
11329 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011330
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011331 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011332
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011333
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011334stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11336 Access control for statistics
11337
11338 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11339 no | no | yes | yes
11340
11341 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11342 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11343 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11344 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11345 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11346 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11347
11348 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11349 instance.
11350
11351 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11352 about ACL usage.
11353
11354
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011355stats realm <realm>
11356 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011358 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011359 Arguments :
11360 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11361 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11362 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11363
11364 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11365 using a backslash ('\').
11366
11367 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11368 only related to authentication.
11369
11370 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11371 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11372 unobvious parameters.
11373
11374 Example :
11375 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11376 backend public_www
11377 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11378 stats enable
11379 stats hide-version
11380 stats scope .
11381 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011382 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011383 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11384 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11385
11386 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11387 backend private_monitoring
11388 stats enable
11389 stats uri /admin?stats
11390 stats refresh 5s
11391
11392 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11393
11394
11395stats refresh <delay>
11396 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011398 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011399 Arguments :
11400 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11401 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11402 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11403 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11404 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11405 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11406
11407 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11408 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11409 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011410 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011411
11412 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11413 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11414 unobvious parameters.
11415
11416 Example :
11417 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11418 backend public_www
11419 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11420 stats enable
11421 stats hide-version
11422 stats scope .
11423 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011424 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011425 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11426 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11427
11428 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11429 backend private_monitoring
11430 stats enable
11431 stats uri /admin?stats
11432 stats refresh 5s
11433
11434 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11435
11436
11437stats scope { <name> | "." }
11438 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011440 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011441 Arguments :
11442 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11443 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11444 section in which the statement appears.
11445
11446 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11447 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11448 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11449 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11450 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11451 exists.
11452
11453 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11454 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11455 unobvious parameters.
11456
11457 Example :
11458 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11459 backend public_www
11460 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11461 stats enable
11462 stats hide-version
11463 stats scope .
11464 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011465 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011466 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11467 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11468
11469 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11470 backend private_monitoring
11471 stats enable
11472 stats uri /admin?stats
11473 stats refresh 5s
11474
11475 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11476
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011477
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011478stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011479 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011481 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011482
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011483 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011484 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11485
11486 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11487 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11488
11489 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11490 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011491 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011492
11493 Example :
11494 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11495 backend private_monitoring
11496 stats enable
11497 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11498 stats uri /admin?stats
11499 stats refresh 5s
11500
11501 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11502 global section.
11503
11504
11505stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011506 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11508 yes | yes | yes | yes
11509 Arguments : none
11510
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011511 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011512 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11513 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11514 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11515 - IP (socket, server)
11516 - cookie (backend, server)
11517
11518 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11519 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011520 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011521
11522 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11523
11524
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011525stats show-modules
11526 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11528 yes | yes | yes | yes
11529 Arguments : none
11530
11531 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11532 values as a tooltip.
11533
11534 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11535 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11536 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11537
11538 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11539
11540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011541stats show-node [ <name> ]
11542 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011544 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011545 Arguments:
11546 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11547 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11548
11549 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11550 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011551 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011552
11553 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11554 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11555 unobvious parameters.
11556
11557 Example:
11558 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11559 backend private_monitoring
11560 stats enable
11561 stats show-node Europe-1
11562 stats uri /admin?stats
11563 stats refresh 5s
11564
11565 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11566 section.
11567
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011568
11569stats uri <prefix>
11570 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011572 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011573 Arguments :
11574 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11575 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11576 query string.
11577
11578 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11579 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11580 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11581 possible to reach it in the application.
11582
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011583 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011584 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011585 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11586 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11587 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11588 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11589
11590 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11591 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11592 an address or a port to statistics only.
11593
11594 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11595 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11596 unobvious parameters.
11597
11598 Example :
11599 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11600 backend public_www
11601 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11602 stats enable
11603 stats hide-version
11604 stats scope .
11605 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011606 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011607 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11608 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11609
11610 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11611 backend private_monitoring
11612 stats enable
11613 stats uri /admin?stats
11614 stats refresh 5s
11615
11616 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11617
11618
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011619stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11620 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011622 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011623
11624 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011625 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011626 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011627 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011628 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11629
11630 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11631 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11632 the "stick-table" statement.
11633
11634 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11635 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11636 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11637 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11638 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11639
11640 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11641 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11642 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11643 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11644 transformation rules.
11645
11646 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11647 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11648 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11649 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11650 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11651 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11652 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11653
11654 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11655 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11656 ACL based conditions.
11657
11658 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11659 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11660 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11661 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11662
11663 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11664 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11665 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11666 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11667
11668 Example :
11669 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11670 # last 30 minutes
11671 backend pop
11672 mode tcp
11673 balance roundrobin
11674 stick store-request src
11675 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11676 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11677 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11678
11679 backend smtp
11680 mode tcp
11681 balance roundrobin
11682 stick match src table pop
11683 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11684 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11685
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011686 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11687 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011688
11689
11690stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11691 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11693 no | no | yes | yes
11694
11695 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11696 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11697 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11698 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11699
11700 Examples :
11701 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011702 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011703
11704 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11705 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11706 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11707
11708
11709 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11710 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11711 backend http
11712 mode http
11713 balance roundrobin
11714 stick on src table https
11715 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11716 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11717 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11718
11719 backend https
11720 mode tcp
11721 balance roundrobin
11722 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11723 stick on src
11724 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11725 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11726
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011727 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011728
11729
11730stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11731 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11733 no | no | yes | yes
11734
11735 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011736 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011737 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011738 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011739 server is selected.
11740
11741 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11742 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11743 the "stick-table" statement.
11744
11745 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11746 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11747 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11748 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11749 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11750 address.
11751
11752 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11753 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11754 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11755 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11756 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11757 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11758 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11759 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11760 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11761 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11762
11763 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11764 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11765 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11766 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11767 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11768 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11769 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11770
11771 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11772 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11773 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11774 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11775
11776 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11777 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11778 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11779 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11780 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11781 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011782 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11783 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11784 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11785 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11786 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11787 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011788
11789 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11790 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11791 the request.
11792
11793 Example :
11794 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11795 # last 30 minutes
11796 backend pop
11797 mode tcp
11798 balance roundrobin
11799 stick store-request src
11800 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11801 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11802 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11803
11804 backend smtp
11805 mode tcp
11806 balance roundrobin
11807 stick match src table pop
11808 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11809 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11810
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011811 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011812
11813
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011814stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011815 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011816 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011817 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011819 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011820
11821 Arguments :
11822 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11823 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11824 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11825 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11826
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011827 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11828 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11829 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11830 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11831
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011832 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11833 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11834 instance.
11835
11836 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11837 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11838 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11839 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11840 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11841 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011842 to 32 characters.
11843
11844 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11845 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11846 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011847 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011848 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11849 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011850
11851 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011852 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11853 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011854 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11855 increase.
11856
11857 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011858 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11859 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11860 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011861
11862 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011863 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011864 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11865 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011866 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011867 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11868 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11869 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11870 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11871 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11872 parameter (see below).
11873
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011874 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11875 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11876 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11877 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11878 soft restart.
11879
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011880 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011881 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11882 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011883 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11884 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011885 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011886 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011887 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11888 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011889 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11890 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011891
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011892 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11893 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11894 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11895 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11896 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11897 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11898 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11899 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11900 token.
11901
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011902 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11903 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11904 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11905 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011906 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11907 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11908 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11909 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11910 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11911 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11912 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11913 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11914 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11915 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11916 types and their arguments.
11917
11918 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11919 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11920 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11921 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11922
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011923 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11924 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11925 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11926 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11927 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11928 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11929 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11930 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11931 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11932 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011933 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11934 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11935 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11936 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011937
11938 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11939 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11940 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11941 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11942 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11943 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010011944 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
11945 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
11946 update message can fit into the buffer.
11947 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
11948 store only the counter gpc0.
11949 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011950 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11951 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11952 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011953 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11954 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11955 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11956 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011957
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011958 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11959 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11960 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011961 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011962
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011963 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11964 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11965 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011966 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011967 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011968 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011969
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011970 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11971 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11972 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11973 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11974
11975 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11976 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11977 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11978 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11979 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11980 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11981
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011982 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11983 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11984 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11985 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11986 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010011987 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
11988 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
11989 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
11990 to store only the tag gpt0.
11991 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
11992 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
11993 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011994 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11995 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11996 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011997
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011998 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11999 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12000 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12001 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12002
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012003 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12004 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12005 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12006 they were received.
12007
12008 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12009 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12010 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12011 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12012 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12013
12014 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12015 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12016 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12017 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12018 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12019
12020 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12021 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12022 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12023
12024 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12025 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12026 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12027 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12028 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12029
12030 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12031 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12032 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12033 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12034 the client side.
12035
12036 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12037 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12038 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12039 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12040 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12041 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12042 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12043
12044 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12045 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12046 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12047 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12048 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12049 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012050 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012051
12052 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12053 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12054 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12055 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12056 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12057 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12058
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012059 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12060 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12061 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12062 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12063 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12064
12065 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12066 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12067 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12068 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12069 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12070 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12071
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012072 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012073 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012074 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12075 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12076
12077 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12078 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12079 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12080 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12081 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12082 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12083 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12084 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12085 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12086 recommended for better fairness.
12087
12088 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012089 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012090 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12091 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12092
12093 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12094 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12095 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12096 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12097 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12098 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12099 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12100 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12101 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12102 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012103
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012104 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12105 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012106 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12107 reference it.
12108
12109 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12110 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012111 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12112 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12113 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012114
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012115 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12116 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12117 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12118 something that can be ignored.
12119
12120 Example:
12121 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12122 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12123 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12124 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12125
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012126 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012127 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012128
12129
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012130stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012131 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12133 no | no | yes | yes
12134
12135 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012136 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012137 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012138 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012139 server is selected.
12140
12141 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12142 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12143 the "stick-table" statement.
12144
12145 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12146 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12147 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12148 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12149
12150 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12151 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12152 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12153 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12154 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12155 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012156 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012157 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12158 rules.
12159
12160 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12161 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12162 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12163 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12164 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12165 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12166 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12167
12168 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12169 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12170 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12171 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12172
12173 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12174 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12175 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12176 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12177 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12178 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012179 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12180 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12181 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12182 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12183 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12184 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12185 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12186 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12187 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012188
12189 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12190
12191 Example :
12192 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12193 backend https
12194 mode tcp
12195 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012196 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012197 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012198
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012199 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12200 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012201
12202 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12203 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12204 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12205
12206 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12207 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012208
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012209 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12210 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12211 # at offset 44.
12212
12213 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012214 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012215
12216 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012217 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012218
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012219 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12220 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12221
12222 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12223 extraction.
12224
12225
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012226tcp-check comment <string>
12227 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12228 it fails.
12229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12230 yes | no | yes | yes
12231
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012232 Arguments :
12233 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12234 rule fails.
12235
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012236 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12237 user-friendly error reporting.
12238
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012239 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12240 "tcp-check expect".
12241
12242
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012243tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12244 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012245 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012246 Opens a new connection
12247 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012248 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012249
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012250 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012251 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12252
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012253 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012254 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012255
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012256 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012257 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12258 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012259 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012260
12261 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012262
12263 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12264
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012265 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12266
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012267 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12268
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012269 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12270
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012271 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12272 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12273 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12274 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12275
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012276 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12277 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12278 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12279 haproxy -vv.
12280
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012281 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012282
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012283 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12284 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12285 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12286
12287 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12288 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12289 of the sequence.
12290
12291 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12292 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12293 do.
12294
12295 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12296 unset-var or comment rules.
12297
12298 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012299 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12300 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12301 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12302 option tcp-check
12303 tcp-check connect
12304 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12305 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12306 tcp-check send \r\n
12307 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12308 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12309 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12310 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12311 tcp-check send \r\n
12312 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12313 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12314
12315 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12316 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012317 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012318 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12319 tcp-check connect port 143
12320 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12321 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12322
12323 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12324
12325
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012326tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012327 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012328 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012329 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012330 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012332 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012333
12334 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012335 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12336
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012337 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12338 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12339 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12340 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12341 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12342 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12343 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12344 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12345 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12346 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12347
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012348 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012349 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12350 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012351 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12352 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12353 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12354
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012355 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12356 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12357 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012358 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12359 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012360 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12361 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012362 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12363 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012364 By default "L7OK" is used.
12365
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012366 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12367 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012368 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12369 supported :
12370 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12371 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012372 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12373 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12374 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12375 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12376 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012377
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012378 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012379 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012380 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12381 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12382 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12383 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012384 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12385
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012386 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12387 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12388 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12389 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12390
12391 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12392 informational message reported in logs if an error
12393 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12394 log-format string.
12395
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012396 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12397 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12398 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12399 followed by some converters.
12400
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012401 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12402 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12403 with the usual backslash ('\').
12404 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012405 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012406 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12407 used upper or lower case.
12408
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012409 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12410
12411 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12412 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12413 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12414 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12415 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12416 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12417 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12418 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12419
12420 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12421 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12422 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12423 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12424 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12425 expression.
12426
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012427 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12428 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12429 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12430 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12431 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12432 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12433
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012434 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12435 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12436 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12437 this exact hexadecimal string.
12438 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12439
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012440 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12441 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12442 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12443 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12444 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12445 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12446 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12447 size.
12448
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012449 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12450 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12451 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12452 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12453 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12454 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12455 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12456 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12457 in a binary string before matching the response's
12458 buffer.
12459
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012460 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012461 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012462 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12463 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12464 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12465 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12466 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12467 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12468 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12469 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12470 the null character.
12471
12472 Examples :
12473 # perform a POP check
12474 option tcp-check
12475 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12476
12477 # perform an IMAP check
12478 option tcp-check
12479 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12480
12481 # look for the redis master server
12482 option tcp-check
12483 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012484 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012485 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12486 tcp-check expect string role:master
12487 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12488 tcp-check expect string +OK
12489
12490
12491 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012492 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012493
12494
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012495tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12496tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12497 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12498 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012499 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012500 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012501
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012502 Arguments :
12503 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12504
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012505 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12506 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012507
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012508 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12509 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012510
12511 Examples :
12512 # look for the redis master server
12513 option tcp-check
12514 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12515 tcp-check expect string role:master
12516
12517 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012518 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012519
12520
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012521tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12522tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12523 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12524 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012526 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012527
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012528 Arguments :
12529 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012530
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012531 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12532 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012533
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012534 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12535 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12536 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012537
12538 Examples :
12539 # redis check in binary
12540 option tcp-check
12541 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12542 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12543
12544
12545 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012546 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012547
12548
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012549tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12550tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012551 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012552 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012553 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012555 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012556 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12557 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12558 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12559 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12560 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12561 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12562 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12563 and '-'.
12564
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012565 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12566 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012567 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012568 conditions.
12569
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012570 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12571
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012572 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12573 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12574
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012575 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012576 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012577 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012578
12579
12580tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012581 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012583 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012585 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012586 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12587 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12588 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12589 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12590 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12591 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12592 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12593 and '-'.
12594
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012595 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012596 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12597
12598
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012599tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012600 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012602 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012603 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012604 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12605 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012606
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012607 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012608
12609 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12610 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012611 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12612 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12613 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12614 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12615 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12616 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012618 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12619 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12620 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012621 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12622 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12623 is true.
12624
12625 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12626 supported:
12627 - accept
12628 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12629 - expect-proxy layer4
12630 - reject
12631 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12632 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12633 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12634 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12635 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12636 - set-dst <expr>
12637 - set-dst-port <expr>
12638 - set-mark <mark>
12639 - set-src <expr>
12640 - set-src-port <expr>
12641 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012642 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12643 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012644 - silent-drop
12645 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12646 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12647 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012648 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012649
12650 The supported actions are described below.
12651
12652 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12653 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012654
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012655 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12656 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12657 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12658 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12659 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12660 a defaults section defining such rules.
12661
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012662 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12663 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12664 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012665
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012666 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12667 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12668 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012669
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012670 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12671 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12672 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012673
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012674 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12675 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12676 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012677
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012678 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12679 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12680 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012681
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012682 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012683
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012684 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012685
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012686 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012687
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012688 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012689
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012690tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012691
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012692 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12693 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012694
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012695tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12696 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012697
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012698 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12699 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12700 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12701 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12702 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12703 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12704 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012705
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012706tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012707
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012708 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12709 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12710 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12711 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12712 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12713 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012714
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012715tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012716
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012717 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12718 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12719 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12720 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12721 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12722 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12723 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12724 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12725 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12726 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12727 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012728
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012729tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12730tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12731tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012732
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012733 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12734 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12735 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12736 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012737
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012738tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12739 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12740tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12741 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012742
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012743 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12744 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12745 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012746
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012747tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12748tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012749
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012750 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12751 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12752 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012753
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012754tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012755
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012756 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12757 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12758 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012759
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012760tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12761tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012762
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012763 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12764 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12765 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012766
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012767tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012768
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012769 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12770 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12771 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012772
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012773tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12774tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012775
12776 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12777 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12778 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12779 for a complete description.
12780
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010012781tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012782
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012783 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12784 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12785 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12786 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012787
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012788tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12789tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12790tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012791
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012792 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12793 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12794 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012795
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012796tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12797
12798 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12799 details about variables.
12800
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012801
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012802tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12803 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012805 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012806 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012807 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12808 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012809
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012810 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012811
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012812 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012813 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12814 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012815 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12816 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012817
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012818 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12819 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12820 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12821 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012822 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012823 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012824 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12825 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12826 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12827 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012828 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012829 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012830
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012831 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12832 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12833 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12834 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012835
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012836 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12837 supported:
12838 - accept
12839 - capture <sample> len <length>
12840 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12841 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012842 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012843 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012844 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012845 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012846 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012847 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020012848 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012849 - set-dst <expr>
12850 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012851 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012852 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012853 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012854 - set-priority-class <expr>
12855 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012856 - set-src <expr>
12857 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012858 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012859 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12860 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012861 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012862 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012863 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12864 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12865 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012866 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012867 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012868
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012869 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012870
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012871 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12872 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12873 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12874 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12875 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12876 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012877
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012878 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12879 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12880 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12881 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12882 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12883 a defaults section defining such rules.
12884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012885 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012886 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12887 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012888
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012889 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12890 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12891 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12892 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12893 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12894 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012896 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012897 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12898 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12899 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12900 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12901 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12902 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12903 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12904 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12905 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12906 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012907
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012908 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012909 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12910 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12911 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012912
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012913 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012914 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012915
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012916 Example:
12917
12918 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012919 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012920 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012921
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012922 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012923 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012924 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012925 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12926 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012927 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012928 tcp-request content reject
12929
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012930 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12931 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12932 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12933 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12934 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12935 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12936 ...
12937 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12938
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012939 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012940 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12941 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012942 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012943 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012944
12945 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12946 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012947 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012948 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012949 tcp-request content reject
12950
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012951 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012952 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012953 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012954 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012955 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12956 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012957
12958 Example:
12959 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12960 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012961 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012962
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012963 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012964 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012965
12966 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012967 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012968 # protecting all our sites
12969 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012970 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12971 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012972 ...
12973 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12974
12975 backend http_dynamic
12976 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012977 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012978 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012979 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012980 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012981 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012982 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012984 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012985
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012986 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12987 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012988
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012989tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12990
12991 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012992 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012993
12994tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12995 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12996
12997 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12998 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12999 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13000 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13001 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13002 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13003 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13004 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13005 information.
13006
13007tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13008
13009 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13010 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13011 complete description.
13012
13013tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13014
13015 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13016 are evaluated.
13017
13018tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13019tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13020tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13021
13022 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13023 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13024 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13025 description.
13026
13027tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13028 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13029tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13030 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13031
13032 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13033 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13034 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13035
13036tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13037 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13038
13039 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13040 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13041
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013042tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
13043 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13044
13045 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13046 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13047 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13048
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013049tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13050tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13051
13052 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13053 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13054 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13055
13056tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13057
13058 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13059 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13060
13061tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13062
13063 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13064 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13065 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13066
13067tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13068
13069 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13070 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13071
13072tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13073
13074 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13075 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13076
13077tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13078
13079 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13080 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13081 description.
13082
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013083tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13084tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13085
13086 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13087 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13088 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13089
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013090tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13091
13092 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13093 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13094 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13095
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013096tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13097tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013098
13099 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13100 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13101 for a complete description.
13102
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013103tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013104
13105 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13106 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13107 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13108 complete description.
13109
13110tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13111 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13112
13113 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13114 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13115 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13116 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13117 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13118 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13119 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13120 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13121 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13122 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13123
13124 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13125
13126tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13127tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13128tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13129
13130 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13131 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13132 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13133
13134tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13135
13136 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13137 details about variables.
13138
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013139tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013140
13141 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13142 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13143 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13144 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13145 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13146
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013147
13148tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13149 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013151 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013152 Arguments :
13153 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13154 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13155 as explained at the top of this document.
13156
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013157 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013158 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13159 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13160 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13161 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13162
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013163 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13164 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13165 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13166 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013168 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013169 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013170 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013171 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013172 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013173 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13174 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13175 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013176
13177 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13178 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13179 it pass through unaffected.
13180
13181 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13182 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13183 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013184 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013185 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13186 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013187 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13188 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13189 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013190
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013191 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13192 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13193
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013194 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013195 "timeout client".
13196
13197
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013198tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13199 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013201 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013202 Arguments :
13203 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13204 below.
13205
13206 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13207
13208 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13209 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13210 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13211 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013212 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013213 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13214 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13215 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13216 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13217 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13218 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13219 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13220 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13221 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13222 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13223 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13224 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13225 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13226 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13227 instead.
13228
13229 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13230 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13231 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13232 rules which may be inserted.
13233
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013234 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13235 supported:
13236 - accept
13237 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013238 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13239 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13240 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13241 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13242 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013243 - set-dst <expr>
13244 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013245 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013246 - set-src <expr>
13247 - set-src-port <expr>
13248 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013249 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13250 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013251 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013252 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13253 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13254 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13255 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013256
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013257 The supported actions are described below.
13258
13259 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13260 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13261 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13262 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13263 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13264 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013265
13266 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13267 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13268 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13269
13270 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13271 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13272 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13273 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13274 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13275
13276 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13277 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13278
13279 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13280 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13281 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13282
13283 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13284 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13285 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13286
13287 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13288 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13289 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13290
13291 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13292 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13293 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13294
13295 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13296
13297 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13298
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013299tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13300
13301 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13302 rules are evaluated.
13303
13304tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13305
13306 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13307 are evaluated.
13308
13309tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13310tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13311tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13312
13313 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13314 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13315 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13316 description.
13317
13318tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13319 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13320tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13322
13323 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13324 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13325 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13326 description.
13327
13328tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13329tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13330
13331 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13332 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13333 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13334
13335tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13336
13337 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13338 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13339 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13340
13341tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13342tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13343
13344 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13345 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13346 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13347
13348tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13349
13350 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13351 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13352 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13353
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013354tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13355tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013356
13357 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13358 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13359 for a complete description.
13360
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013361tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013362
13363 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13364 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13365 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13366 complete description.
13367
13368tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13369tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13370tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13371
13372 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13373 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13374 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13375
13376tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13377
13378 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13379 details about variables.
13380
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013381
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013382tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13383 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013385 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013386 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013387 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13388 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013389
13390 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013392 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013393 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13394 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013395 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13396 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013397
13398 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13399
13400 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13401 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13402 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13403 inserted.
13404
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013405 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13406 supported:
13407 - accept
13408 - close
13409 - reject
13410 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13411 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13412 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13413 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13414 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13415 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013416 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013417 - set-log-level <level>
13418 - set-mark <mark>
13419 - set-nice <nice>
13420 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013421 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13422 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013423 - silent-drop
13424 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13425
13426 The supported actions are described below.
13427
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013428 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13429 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13430 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13431 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13432 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13433 a defaults section defining such rules.
13434
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013435 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13436 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13437 for changing the default action to a reject.
13438
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013439 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013441 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13442 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13443 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13444 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13445 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013446
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013447 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013448
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013449 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013450
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013451tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013452
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013453 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13454 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013455
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013456tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013457
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013458 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13459 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13460 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13461 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13462 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13463 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013464
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013465tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013466
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013467 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13468 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013469
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013470tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13471tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13472tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013473
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013474 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13475 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13476 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13477 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013478
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013479tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13481tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013483
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013484 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13485 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13486 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013487
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013488tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13489 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013490
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013491 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13492 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013493
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013494
13495tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit <expr>] [period <expr>]
13496 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13497
13498 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13499 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13500 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13501
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013502tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013503
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013504 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13505 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013506
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013507tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013508
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013509 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13510 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13511 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013512
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013513tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013514
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013515 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13516 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013517
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013518tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013519
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013520 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13521 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13522 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013523
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013524tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13525tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013526
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013527 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13528 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13529 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013530
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013531tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013532
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013533 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13534 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13535 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13536 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013537
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013538tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013539
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013540 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13541 details about variables.
13542
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013543
13544tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13545 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013547 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013548 Arguments :
13549 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13550 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13551 as explained at the top of this document.
13552
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013553 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13554 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013555
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013556 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13557
13558
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013559timeout check <timeout>
13560 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13561 established.
13562
13563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13564 yes | no | yes | yes
13565 Arguments:
13566 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13567 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13568 as explained at the top of this document.
13569
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013570 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013571 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013572 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013573 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013574 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13575 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13576 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013577
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013578 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013579 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13580
13581 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13582 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013583 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013584
13585 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13586 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13587 forget about it.
13588
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013589 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13590 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13591
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013592 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13593 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013594
13595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013596timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013597 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13599 yes | yes | yes | no
13600 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13603 as explained at the top of this document.
13604
13605 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13606 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13607 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013608 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13609 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13610 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13611 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013612 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13613 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13614 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013615 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013616 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13618 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013619 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13620 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013621
13622 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13623 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13624 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13625 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013626 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013627 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13628
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013629 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013630
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013631
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013632timeout client-fin <timeout>
13633 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13635 yes | yes | yes | no
13636 Arguments :
13637 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13638 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13639 as explained at the top of this document.
13640
13641 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13642 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13643 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13644 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13645 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13646 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13647 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013648 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13649 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13650 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013651
13652 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13653 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13654 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13655
13656 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13657
13658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013659timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013660 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13662 yes | no | yes | yes
13663 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013664 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013665 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13666 as explained at the top of this document.
13667
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013668 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013669 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013670 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013671 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013672 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13673 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013674
13675 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13676 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13677 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13678 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013679 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013680 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13681
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013682 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013684
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013685timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13686 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13688 yes | yes | yes | yes
13689 Arguments :
13690 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13691 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13692 as explained at the top of this document.
13693
13694 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13695 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13696 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13697 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13698 once the request has started to present itself.
13699
13700 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13701 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13702 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13703 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13704 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13705
13706 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13707 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13708 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13709 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13710
13711 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13712 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013713 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013714 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13715 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013716 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013717
13718 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13719 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13720 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13721 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13722
13723 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13724
13725
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013726timeout http-request <timeout>
13727 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013729 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013730 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013731 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013732 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13733 as explained at the top of this document.
13734
13735 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13736 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13737 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13738 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13739 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13740 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13741 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013742 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13743 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13744 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13745 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013747 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13748 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013749
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013750 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13751 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13752 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13753 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13754 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013755 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013756
13757 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13758 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013759 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013760 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13761 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13762
13763 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013764 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13765 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13766 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013767
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013768 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013769 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013770
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013771
13772timeout queue <timeout>
13773 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13775 yes | no | yes | yes
13776 Arguments :
13777 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13778 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13779 as explained at the top of this document.
13780
13781 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13782 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13783 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13784 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13785 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13786
13787 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13788 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13789 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13790 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13791
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013792 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013793
13794
13795timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013796 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13798 yes | no | yes | yes
13799 Arguments :
13800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13802 as explained at the top of this document.
13803
13804 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13805 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13806 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13807 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13808 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13809 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13810 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13811
13812 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13813 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13814 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13815 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13816 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013817 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013818 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013819 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13820 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013821 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13822 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013823
13824 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13825 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13826 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13827 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013828 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013829 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13830
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013831 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013832
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013833
13834timeout server-fin <timeout>
13835 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13837 yes | no | yes | yes
13838 Arguments :
13839 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13841 as explained at the top of this document.
13842
13843 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13844 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13845 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13846 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13847 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13848 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13849 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13850 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13851 situations, it should not be needed.
13852
13853 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13854 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13855 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13856
13857 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13858
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013859
13860timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013861 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13863 yes | yes | yes | yes
13864 Arguments :
13865 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13867 as explained at the top of this document.
13868
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013869 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13870 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13871 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013872
13873 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13874 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13875 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13876 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013877 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013878
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013879 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013880
13881
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013882timeout tunnel <timeout>
13883 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13885 yes | no | yes | yes
13886 Arguments :
13887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13889 as explained at the top of this document.
13890
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013891 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013892 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13893 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13894 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013895 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13896 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013897 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13898 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13899 specified.
13900
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013901 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13902 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13903 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13904 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13905 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13906 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13907 state.
13908
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013909 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13910 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13911 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13912 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013914
13915 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13916 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13917 forget about it.
13918
13919 Example :
13920 defaults http
13921 option http-server-close
13922 timeout connect 5s
13923 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013924 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013925 timeout server 30s
13926 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13927
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013928 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013929
13930
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013931transparent (deprecated)
13932 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013934 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013935 Arguments : none
13936
13937 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13938 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13939 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13940 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13941 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13942 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13943 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13944 appropriate server.
13945
13946 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13947
13948 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13949 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13950
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013951 See also: "option transparent"
13952
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013953unique-id-format <string>
13954 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13956 yes | yes | yes | no
13957 Arguments :
13958 <string> is a log-format string.
13959
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013960 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13961 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13962 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13963 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013964
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013965 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013966 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013967 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13968 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13969 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13970 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13971 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13972 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013973
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013974 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13975 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013976
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013977 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013978
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013979 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013980
13981 will generate:
13982
13983 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13984
13985 See also: "unique-id-header"
13986
13987unique-id-header <name>
13988 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13990 yes | yes | yes | no
13991 Arguments :
13992 <name> is the name of the header.
13993
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013994 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13995 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013996
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013997 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013998
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013999 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014000 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14001
14002 will generate:
14003
14004 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14005
14006 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014007
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014008use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014009 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14011 no | yes | yes | no
14012 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014013 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14014 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014015
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014016 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14017 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014018
14019 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14020 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14021 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014022 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014023 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014024 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14025 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014026
14027 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14028 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14029 assign the backend.
14030
14031 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14032 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14033 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14034 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14035 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14036 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14037
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014038 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014039 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014040 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14041 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14042 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14043
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014044 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14045 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14046 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14047 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14048 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14049 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14050 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14051 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14052 cannot be forced from the request.
14053
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014054 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014055 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14056 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14057
14058 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14059 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014060
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014061use-fcgi-app <name>
14062 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14064 no | no | yes | yes
14065 Arguments :
14066 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14067
14068 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014069
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014070use-server <server> if <condition>
14071use-server <server> unless <condition>
14072 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14074 no | no | yes | yes
14075 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014076 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14077 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014078
14079 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14080
14081 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14082 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14083 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14084
14085 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14086 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14087 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14088 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14089 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14090 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14091 matches will assign the server.
14092
14093 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14094 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14095 with the next rules until one matches.
14096
14097 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14098 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14099 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14100 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14101
14102 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14103 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14104 stripped.
14105
14106 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14107 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014108 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014109 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014110 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014111
14112 Example :
14113 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014114 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014115 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014116 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014117 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014118 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014119 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014120 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14121 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14122
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014123 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14124 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14125 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14126 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014127 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014128 and we fall back to load balancing.
14129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014130 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141335. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014134--------------------------
14135
14136The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14137depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14138settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14139written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14140described in this section.
14141
14142
141435.1. Bind options
14144-----------------
14145
14146The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14147as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14148no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14149parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14150while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14151provided immediately after the setting name.
14152
14153The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14154
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014155accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14156 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14157 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14158 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14159 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14160 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14161 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14162 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14163 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14164 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014165 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14166 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14167 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014168
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014169accept-proxy
14170 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014171 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14172 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014173 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14174 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14175 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14176 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014177 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014178 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14179 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014180 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14181 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014182
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014183allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014184 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014185 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014186 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014187 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14188 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014189
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014190alpn <protocols>
14191 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14192 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14193 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014194 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014195 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014196 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14197 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14198 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14199 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14200 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14201 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14202 preference, like below :
14203
14204 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014205
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014206 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14207 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14208
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014209backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014210 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014211 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14212
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014213curves <curves>
14214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14215 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14216 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14217 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14218 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14219 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14220
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014221ecdhe <named curve>
14222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014223 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14224 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014225
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014226ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14228 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014229 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14230 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014231 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014232
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014233 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14234 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14235 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14236 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14237 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014238 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014239
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014240ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14242 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014243 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14244 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14245 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14246 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14247 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014248 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14249 error is ignored.
14250
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014251ca-sign-file <cafile>
14252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14253 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14254 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14255 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14256 'generate-certificates' for details.
14257
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014258ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14260 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14261 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14262 'generate-certificates' for details.
14263
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014264ca-verify-file <cafile>
14265 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14266 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14267 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14268 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14269 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14270
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014271ciphers <ciphers>
14272 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14273 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014274 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014275 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014276 information and recommendations see e.g.
14277 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14278 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14279 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14280
14281ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14283 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14284 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14285 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014286 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14287 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014288
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014289crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14291 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014292 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14293 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014294
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014295crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014296 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14297 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14298 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14299 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14300 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014301 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14302 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014303
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014304 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14305 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14306
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014307 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14308 are loaded.
14309
14310 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014311 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014312 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14313 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14314 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14315 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14316 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14317 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14318 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14319 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014320
14321 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14322 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14323 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14324 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014325 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14326 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014327
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014328 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014329
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014330 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014331 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014332 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14333 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014334 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14335 clients).
14336
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014337 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014338 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14339 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14340 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14341 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14342 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14343 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14344 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14345 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14346 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14347 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14348 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14349 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14350
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014351 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014352 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14353 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14354 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14355 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14356
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014357 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14358 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14359 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14360 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014361
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014362 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14363 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14364 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014365
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014366crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014368 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14369 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14370 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14371 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14372 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14373 in new version of OpenSSL.
14374 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14375 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014376
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014377crt-list <file>
14378 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014379 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14380 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014381
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014382 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14383
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014384 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14385 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14386 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14387 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14388 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014389
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014390 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014391 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14392 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14393 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14394 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14395 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014396 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14397 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14398 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014399
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014400 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14401 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14402 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014403
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014404 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14405
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014406 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014407 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014408 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14409 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14410 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14411 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14412 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14413 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014414
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014415 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014416 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014417 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014418 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014419 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014420 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014421
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014422defer-accept
14423 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14424 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14425 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014426 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014427 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14428 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14429 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14430 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14431 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14432 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14433 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14434
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014435expose-fd listeners
14436 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14437 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014438 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14439 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014440 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014441
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014442force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014443 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014444 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014445 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014446 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014447
14448force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014449 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014450 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014451 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014452
14453force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014454 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014455 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014456 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014457
14458force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014459 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014460 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014461 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014462
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014463force-tlsv13
14464 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14465 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014466 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014467
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014468generate-certificates
14469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14470 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14471 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14472 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14473 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14474 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14475 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14476 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14477 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14478 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14479 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14480
14481 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14482 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014483 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014484 certificate is used many times.
14485
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014486gid <gid>
14487 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14488 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14489 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14490 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14491 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14492
14493group <group>
14494 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14495 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14496 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14497 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14498 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14499
14500id <id>
14501 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14502 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14503 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14504 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14505
14506interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014507 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14508 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14509 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14510 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14511 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14512 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014513 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14514 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14515 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14516 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14517 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14518 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014519
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014520level <level>
14521 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14522 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14523 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014524 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014525 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14526 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14527 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014528 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014529 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014530 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014531 all counters).
14532
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014533severity-output <format>
14534 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14535 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14536 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14537 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14538 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14539 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14540 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14541 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14542 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14543 rfc5424 convention.
14544
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014545maxconn <maxconn>
14546 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14547 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14548 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14549 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14550 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14551 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14552 eat all memory.
14553
14554mode <mode>
14555 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14556 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14557 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14558 UNIX sockets.
14559
14560mss <maxseg>
14561 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14562 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14563 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14564 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14565 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14566 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14567 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14568 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14569 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14570 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14571 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14572
14573name <name>
14574 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14575 page.
14576
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014577namespace <name>
14578 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14579 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14580 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14581 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14582
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014583nice <nice>
14584 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14585 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14586 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14587 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14588 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14589 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14590 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14591 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14592 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14593 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14594 one for an RDP socket.
14595
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014596no-ca-names
14597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14598 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014599 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014600
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014601no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014603 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014604 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014605 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014606 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14607 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014608
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014609no-tls-tickets
14610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14611 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14612 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014613 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14614 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014615 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14616 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14617 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014618
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014619no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014620 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014621 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014622 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014623 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014624 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14625 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014626
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014627no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014629 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014630 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014631 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014632 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14633 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014634
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014635no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014636 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014637 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014638 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014639 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014640 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14641 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014642
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014643no-tlsv13
14644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14645 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14646 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14647 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014648 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14649 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014650
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014651npn <protocols>
14652 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14653 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14654 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014655 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014656 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014657 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14658 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14659 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14660 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14661 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014662
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010014663ocsp-update [ off | on ]
14664 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
14665 Its value defaults to 'off'.
14666 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
14667 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
14668 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
14669 raised.
14670 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
14671 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
14672 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
14673 the OCSP certid to be built.
14674 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
14675 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
14676 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
14677 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
14678 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
14679 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
14680 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
14681 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
14682 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
14683 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
14684 short time after init.
14685 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
14686 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
14687 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
14688
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014689prefer-client-ciphers
14690 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14691 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14692 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014693 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14694 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14695 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014696
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014697proto <name>
14698 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14699 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14700 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014701 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14702 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14703
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014704 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14705 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14706 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014707
14708 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14709 a bind line :
14710
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014711 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014712 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14713 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14714
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014715 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014716 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014717 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014718 h2" on the bind line.
14719
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020014720quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
14721 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14722
14723 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
14724 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
14725 to those used by TCP.
14726
14727 Default value: cubic
14728
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014729quic-force-retry
14730 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14731 change without deprecation in the future.
14732
14733 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14734 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14735 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14736 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14737 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14738 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
14739 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010014740 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
14741
14742 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
14743 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014744
14745 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
14746 information about QUIC retry.
14747
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014748shards <number> | by-thread
14749 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14750 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14751 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14752 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14753 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14754 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14755 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14756 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14757 little bit.
14758
14759 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14760 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14761 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14762 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14763 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14764 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14765
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014766ssl
14767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014768 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014769 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14770 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014771 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14772 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014773
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014774ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14775 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014776 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14777 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14778 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014779 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14780
14781ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014782 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14783 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14784 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14785 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014786
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014787strict-sni
14788 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14789 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14790 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14791 See the "crt" option for more information.
14792
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014793tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014794 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014795 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014796 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014797 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014798 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14799 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14800 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14801 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14802 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14803 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14804 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14805
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014806tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014807 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014808 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14809 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14810 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14811 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14812 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14813 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14814 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014815 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14816 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14817 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014818
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014819thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014820 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14821 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14822 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014823
14824 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14825 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14826 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14827 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14828 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14829 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14830 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14831 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14832 of the parsing.
14833
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014834 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014835 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14836 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014837
14838 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14839
14840 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14841 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14842 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14843 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14844 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14845 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14846
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014847tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14848 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014849 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14850 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14851 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14852 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14853 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14854 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14855 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14856 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14857 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14858 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014859 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14860 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014862transparent
14863 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14864 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14865 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14866 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14867 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14868 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14869 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14870 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14871 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14872 so check for support with your vendor.
14873
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014874v4v6
14875 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14876 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14877 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14878 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014879 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014880
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014881v6only
14882 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14883 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14884 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014885 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14886 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014887
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014888uid <uid>
14889 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14890 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14891 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14892 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14893 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14894
14895user <user>
14896 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14897 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14898 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14899 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14900 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14901
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014902verify [none|optional|required]
14903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14904 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14905 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14906 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14907 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014908 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14909 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14910 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14911 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014912
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200149135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014914------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014916The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14917which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14918arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14919settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14920after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14921Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14922address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014924 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014925 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014926
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014927Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14928keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014930The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014931
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014932addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014933 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014934 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14935 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14936 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14937 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14938 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014939
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014940agent-check
14941 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014942 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014943 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14944 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14945 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014946
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014947 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014948 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014949 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014950 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14951 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014952
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14954 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14955 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14956 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14957 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014958
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014959 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014961
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014962 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14963 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14964 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014965
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014966 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14967 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14968 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014969
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014970 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014971 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14972 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14973 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14974 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014975 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014976 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014977
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014978 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14979 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014980
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014981 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14982 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14983 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14984 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14985 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14986 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14987 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14988 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14989 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014990
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014991 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14992 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014993 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14994 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14995 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014996 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014997
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014998 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014999 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015000
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015001agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015002 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015003 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15004 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15005 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15006 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15007
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015008agent-inter <delay>
15009 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15010 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15011
15012 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15013 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15014 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15015 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15016 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15017 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15018 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15019 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15020 of backends use the same servers.
15021
15022 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15023
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015024agent-addr <addr>
15025 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15026
15027 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015028 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015029 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15030 hostname, it will be resolved.
15031
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015032agent-port <port>
15033 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15034
15035 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15036
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015037allow-0rtt
15038 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015039 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15040 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015041
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015042alpn <protocols>
15043 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15044 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15045 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015046 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015047 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15048 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15049 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15050 now obsolete NPN extension.
15051 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15052 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15053
15054 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15055
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015056 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015058backup
15059 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15060 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15061 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15062 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015063 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15064 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015065
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015066ca-file <cafile>
15067 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15068 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015069 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15070 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015071 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015072
15073 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15074 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15075 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015077check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015078 This option enables health checks on a server:
15079 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15080 considered available.
15081 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15082 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15083 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15084 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15085 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015086 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15087 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015088 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15089 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15090 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15091 exchanges succeed.
15092
15093 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15094 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15095 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15096 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15097 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015098 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015099 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15100
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015101 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015102 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015103 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15104 not overridden.
15105
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015106 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15107 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15108
15109 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15110 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15111
15112 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15113 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15114 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15115 available.
15116
15117 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15118 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15119 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15120
15121 Example:
15122 # simple tcp check
15123 backend foo
15124 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15125 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15126 backend foo
15127 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15128 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15129 backend foo
15130 option tcp-check
15131 tcp-check connect
15132 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015133
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015134check-send-proxy
15135 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15136 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15137 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15138 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15139 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15140 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15141 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15142
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015143check-alpn <protocols>
15144 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15145 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15146 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15147
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015148check-proto <name>
15149 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15150 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15151 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015152 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15153 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15154
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015155 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15156 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15157 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015158
15159 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15160 directive on a server line:
15161
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015162 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015163 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15164 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15165 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15166
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015167 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015168 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15169 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15170
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015171check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015172 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015173 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15174 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015175
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015176check-ssl
15177 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15178 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15179 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15180 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015181 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015182 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15183 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015184 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015185 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15186 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015187
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015188check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015189 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015190 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15191 for normal traffic.
15192
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015193ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15195 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15196 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015197 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15198 information and recommendations see e.g.
15199 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15200 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15201 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015202
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015203ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15205 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15206 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15207 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015208 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15209 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15210 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015212cookie <value>
15213 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15214 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15215 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15216 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15217 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15218 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15219 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15220
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015221crl-file <crlfile>
15222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15223 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15224 to verify server's certificate.
15225
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015226crt <cert>
15227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15228 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15229 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15230 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15231 certificate request.
15232
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015233 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15234 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15235 option is set accordingly).
15236
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015237disabled
15238 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15239 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15240 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15241 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15242 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015243 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015244
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015245enabled
15246 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15247 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15248 default value.
15249 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15250 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015252error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015253 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15254 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15255 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015257 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015258
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015259fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015260 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15261 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15262 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15263
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015264force-sslv3
15265 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15266 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015267 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015268 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015269
15270force-tlsv10
15271 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015272 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015273 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015274
15275force-tlsv11
15276 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015277 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015278 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015279
15280force-tlsv12
15281 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015282 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015283 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015284
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015285force-tlsv13
15286 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15287 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015288 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015290id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015291 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15292 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15293 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015294
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015295init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15296 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15297 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015298 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015299 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15300 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15301 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15302 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15303 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15304 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15305 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15306 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15307 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015308 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015309 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15310 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15311 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15312 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15313 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15314 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015315 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015316
15317 Example:
15318 defaults
15319 # never fail on address resolution
15320 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015322inter <delay>
15323fastinter <delay>
15324downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015325 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15326 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15327 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15328 between checks depending on the server state :
15329
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015330 Server state | Interval used
15331 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15332 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15333 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15334 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15335 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15336 or yet unchecked. |
15337 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15338 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15339 | "inter" otherwise.
15340 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015342 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15343 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15344 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15345 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015346 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15347 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15348 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15349 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15350 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015351
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015352log-proto <logproto>
15353 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15354 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15355 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15356 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015358maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015359 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15360 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015361 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15362 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015363 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15364 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15365 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15366 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15367
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015368 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15369 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15370 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15371 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15372 than 50 concurrent requests.
15373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015374maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015375 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15376 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15377 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15378 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015379 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15380 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15381 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15382 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15383 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15384 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15385 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015386
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015387max-reuse <count>
15388 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15389 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15390 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15391 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15392 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15393 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15394 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15395 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015397minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015398 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15399 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15400 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15401 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15402 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15403 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015404 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015405 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015406
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015407namespace <name>
15408 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15409 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15410 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15411 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15412
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015413no-agent-check
15414 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15415 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15416 default value.
15417 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15418 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15419
15420no-backup
15421 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15422 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15423 default value.
15424 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15425 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15426
15427no-check
15428 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15429 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15430 default value.
15431 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15432 "default-server" "check" setting.
15433
15434no-check-ssl
15435 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15436 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15437 default value.
15438 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15439 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15440
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015441no-send-proxy
15442 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15443 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15444 default value.
15445 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15446 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15447
15448no-send-proxy-v2
15449 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15450 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15451 default value.
15452 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15453 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15454
15455no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15456 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15457 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15458 default value.
15459 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15460 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15461
15462no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15463 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15464 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15465 default value.
15466 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15467 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15468
15469no-ssl
15470 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15471 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15472 default value.
15473 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15474 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15475
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015476 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15477 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15478 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15479
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015480no-ssl-reuse
15481 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15482 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15483 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15484 and for paranoid users.
15485
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015486no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015487 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15488 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015489 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015490
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015491 Supported in default-server: No
15492
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015493no-tls-tickets
15494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15495 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15496 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015497 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15498 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015499 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15500 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15501 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015502 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015503
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015504no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015505 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015506 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15507 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015508 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15509 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015510 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015511
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015512 Supported in default-server: No
15513
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015514no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015515 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015516 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15517 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015518 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15519 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015520 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015521
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015522 Supported in default-server: No
15523
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015524no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015525 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015526 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15527 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015528 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15529 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015530 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015531
15532 Supported in default-server: No
15533
15534no-tlsv13
15535 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15536 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15537 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15538 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15539 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015540 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015541
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015542 Supported in default-server: No
15543
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015544no-verifyhost
15545 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15546 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15547 default value.
15548 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15549 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015550
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015551no-tfo
15552 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15553 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15554 default value.
15555 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15556 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15557
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015558non-stick
15559 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15560 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15561 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15562
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015563npn <protocols>
15564 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15565 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15566 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015567 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015568 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15569 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15570 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15571
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015572observe <mode>
15573 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15574 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15575 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15576 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15577 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15578 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015579 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015580
15581 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015583on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015584 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15585 Currently, four modes are available:
15586 - fastinter: force fastinter
15587 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15588 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15589 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15590 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15591
15592 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15593
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015594on-marked-down <action>
15595 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15596 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015597 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15598 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15599 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15600 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15601 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15602 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15603 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15604 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015605
15606 Actions are disabled by default
15607
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015608on-marked-up <action>
15609 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15610 Currently one action is available:
15611 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15612 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15613 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15614 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015615 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15616 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015617 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15618 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15619
15620 Actions are disabled by default
15621
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015622pool-low-conn <max>
15623 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15624 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15625 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15626 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15627 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15628 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15629 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15630 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15631 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15632 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015633 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15634 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15635 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15636 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015637
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015638pool-max-conn <max>
15639 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15640 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15641 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15642 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15643 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15644 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15645
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015646pool-purge-delay <delay>
15647 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015648 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015649 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015651port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015652 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015653 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15654 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15655 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15656 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15657 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015658
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015659proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015660 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15661 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15662 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015663 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15664 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15665
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015666 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15667 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15668 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015669
15670 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15671 a server line :
15672
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015673 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015674 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15675 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15676 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15677
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015678 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015679 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15680
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015681 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015683redir <prefix>
15684 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15685 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15686 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15687 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15688 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15689 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15690 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15691 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015692 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015693 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015694 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15695 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15696 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15697 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15698
15699 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015701rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015702 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15703 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15704 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15705
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015706resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15707 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15708 server.
15709
15710 Available options:
15711
15712 * allow-dup-ip
15713 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15714 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15715 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15716 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15717 For such case, simply enable this option.
15718 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15719
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015720 * ignore-weight
15721 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15722 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15723 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15724
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015725 * prevent-dup-ip
15726 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15727 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15728 same fqdn.
15729 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15730
15731 Example:
15732 backend b_myapp
15733 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15734 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15735 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15736
15737 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15738 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15739 it
15740 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15741 different address
15742
15743 Default value: not set
15744
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015745resolve-prefer <family>
15746 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15747 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15748 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15749 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15750
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015751 Default value: ipv6
15752
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015753 Example:
15754
15755 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015756
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015757resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015758 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015759 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015760 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015761 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15762 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015763 configured network, another address is selected.
15764
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015765 Example:
15766
15767 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015768
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015769resolvers <id>
15770 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15771 hostname.
15772
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015773 Example:
15774
15775 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015776
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015777 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015778
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015779send-proxy
15780 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15781 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15782 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15783 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015784 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15785 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15786 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15787 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015788 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015789 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15790 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15791 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15792 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15793 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015794 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15795 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015796
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015797send-proxy-v2
15798 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15799 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15800 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15801 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015802 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15803 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15804 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15805 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015806
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015807proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015808 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15809 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15810
15811 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15812 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15813 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15814 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15815 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15816 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15817 connection is supported).
15818 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15819 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15820 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15821 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15822 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15823 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15824 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015825
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015826send-proxy-v2-ssl
15827 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15828 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15829 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15830 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15831 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15832 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15833 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015834 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15835 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015836
15837send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15838 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15839 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15840 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15841 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15842 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15843 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15844 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15845 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015846 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15847 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015848
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020015849shard <shard>
15850 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
15851 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
15852 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
15853 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
15854 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
15855 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
15856 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
15857
15858 Example :
15859
15860 peers mypeers
15861 shards 3
15862 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
15863 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
15864 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
15865 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
15866
15867
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015868slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015869 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15870 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15871 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15872 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15873 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15874 parameters :
15875
15876 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15877 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15878
15879 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15880 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15881 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15882 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15883
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015884 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015885 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15886 seen as failed.
15887
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015888sni <expression>
15889 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15890 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15891 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015892 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15893 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15894 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15895 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015896 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015897 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015898 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15899 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015900
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015901source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015902source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015903source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015904 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15905 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15906 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15907 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15908
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015909 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15910 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15911 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15912 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15913 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15914 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15915 server.
15916
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015917 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15918 specifying the source address without port(s).
15919
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015920ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015921 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15922 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15923 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15924 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15925 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15926 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015927 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15928 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015929
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015930ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15931 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15932 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15933 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15934
15935ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15936 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15937 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15938 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15939
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015940ssl-reuse
15941 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15942 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15943 default value.
15944 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15945 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15946
15947stick
15948 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15949 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15950 default value.
15951 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15952 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015953
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015954socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015955 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015956 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15957 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15958
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015959tcp-ut <delay>
15960 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015961 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015962 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015963 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015964 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15965 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15966 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15967 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15968 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15969 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15970 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15971 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15972 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15973
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015974tfo
15975 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15976 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15977 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15978 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015979 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015980 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015981
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015982track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015983 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15984 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15985 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15986 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015987 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15988
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015989tls-tickets
15990 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15991 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15992 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015993 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15994 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15995 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015996 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015997 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015998
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015999verify [none|required]
16000 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016001 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016002 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16003 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016004 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016005 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16006 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16007 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16008 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16009 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16010 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16011 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16012 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016013
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016014verifyhost <hostname>
16015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016016 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16017 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16018 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16019 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16020 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16021 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16022 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16023 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016025weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016026 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16027 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16028 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016029 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16030 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16031 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16032 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16033 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16034 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016035
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016036ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16037 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16038 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16039 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16040
16041 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16042 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16043 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16044 server ALPN contains it.
16045
16046 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16047 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16048 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16049 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16050
16051 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16052 favor of the ALPN extension.
16053
16054 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016056
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200160575.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16058-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016059
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016060HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16061using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016062configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016063This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16064can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16065workload.
16066This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16067resolution at run time.
16068Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16069carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16070
16071
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200160725.3.1. Global overview
16073----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016074
16075As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16076different steps of the process life:
16077
16078 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16079 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16080 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16081
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016082 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16083 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016084
16085A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16086 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16087 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16088 resolution to know this new IP.
16089
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016090When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016091HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016092SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16093from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016094will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016095will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016096
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016097A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016098 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016099 first valid response.
16100
16101 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16102 servers return an error.
16103
16104
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200161055.3.2. The resolvers section
16106----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016107
16108This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016109HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16110contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016111
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016112At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16113no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16114default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16115failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16116
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016117When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16118uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16119is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16120answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16121
16122When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016123used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016124
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016125 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16126 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16127 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016128
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016129 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16130 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016131
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016132 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016133 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16134 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016135
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016136For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16137following scenarios are possible:
16138
16139 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16140 ignored
16141
16142 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16143 applied
16144
16145 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16146 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16147
16148 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16149 retries the query with a new type
16150
16151 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16152 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016153
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016154As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016155a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016156<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016157
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016158
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016159resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016160 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016161
16162A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16163
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016164accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016165 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016166 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016167 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16168 by RFC 6891)
16169
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016170 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16171 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16172 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16173 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16174 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16175 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016176
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016177nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16178 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16179 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16180 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16181 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16182 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16183 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16184 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16185 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16186 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016187 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16188
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016189parse-resolv-conf
16190 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16191 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16192 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16193
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016194hold <status> <period>
16195 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
16196 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016197 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016198 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016199 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
16200 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16201 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
16202
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020016203 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016204
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016205resolve_retries <nb>
16206 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16207 giving up.
16208 Default value: 3
16209
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016210 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16211 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16212 type.
16213
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016214timeout <event> <time>
16215 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16216 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16217 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016218 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16219 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016220 Default value: 1s
16221 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016222 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016223 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016224 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16225 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16226
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016227 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016228
16229 resolvers mydns
16230 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16231 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016232 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016233 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016234 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016235 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016236 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016237 hold other 30s
16238 hold refused 30s
16239 hold nx 30s
16240 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016241 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016242 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016243
16244
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200162456. Cache
16246---------
16247
16248HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16249(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16250RAM.
16251
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016252The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16253blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016254
16255If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16256independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16257when we try to allocate a new one.
16258
16259The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16260
16261It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16262"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16263for more details.
16264
16265When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16266replaced by "<CACHE>".
16267
16268
162696.1. Limitation
16270----------------
16271
16272The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16273
16274- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016275- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16276 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16277 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016278- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16279- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016280- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16281 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16282 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016283- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16284 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016285- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16286 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16287 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016288
16289- If the request is not a GET
16290- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16291- If the request contains an Authorization header
16292
16293
162946.2. Setup
16295-----------
16296
16297To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16298the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16299
16300
163016.2.1. Cache section
16302---------------------
16303
16304cache <name>
16305 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16306 size of cache is mandatory.
16307
16308total-max-size <megabytes>
16309 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16310 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16311
16312max-object-size <bytes>
16313 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16314 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16315 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16316
16317max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016318 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016319 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16320 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16321 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16322 default.
16323
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016324process-vary <on/off>
16325 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016326 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16327 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16328 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016329 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016330
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016331max-secondary-entries <number>
16332 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16333 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16334 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16335
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016336
163376.2.2. Proxy section
16338---------------------
16339
16340http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16341 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16342 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16343 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16344 after this one.
16345
16346http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16347 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16348 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16349 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16350 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16351
16352
16353Example:
16354
16355 backend bck1
16356 mode http
16357
16358 http-request cache-use foobar
16359 http-response cache-store foobar
16360 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16361
16362 cache foobar
16363 total-max-size 4
16364 max-age 240
16365
16366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163677. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16368----------------------------------
16369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016370HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16372The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16373these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16374but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16375data called patterns.
16376
16377
163787.1. ACL basics
16379---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016380
16381The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16382content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16383from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16384simple :
16385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016387 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016388 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16389 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016391The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16392adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016393
16394In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016397
16398This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16399Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16400and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016401an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16402conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16403as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16404are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016405
16406ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16407'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16408which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16409
16410There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16411performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016413The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16414specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16415this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016416methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16417ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016418
16419Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16420 - boolean
16421 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16422 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16423 - string
16424 - data block
16425
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016426Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16427converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16428would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16429The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16430which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16431
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016432Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16433keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16434fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16435which are summarized in the table below :
16436
16437 +---------------------+-----------------+
16438 | Sample or converter | Default |
16439 | output type | matching method |
16440 +---------------------+-----------------+
16441 | boolean | bool |
16442 +---------------------+-----------------+
16443 | integer | int |
16444 +---------------------+-----------------+
16445 | ip | ip |
16446 +---------------------+-----------------+
16447 | string | str |
16448 +---------------------+-----------------+
16449 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16450 +---------------------+-----------------+
16451
16452Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16453matching method, see below.
16454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16456 - boolean
16457 - integer or integer range
16458 - IP address / network
16459 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16460 - regular expression
16461 - hex block
16462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016463The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16464
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016465 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16466 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016468 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016469 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016470 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016471 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016473The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16474read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16475if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16476lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16477will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16478beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016479a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16481exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16482
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016483The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16484parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16485ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16486a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16487check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16488
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016489The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16490socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16491file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016493Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16494loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16495
16496 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16497
16498In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16499the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16500case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16501as well.
16502
16503The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16504sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16505do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16506methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16507is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016508obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016509followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16510default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16511that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16512string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16513
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016514The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16515By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16516string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16517resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016518server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016519waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016520flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16521function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16524sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16525be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016526
16527 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16528 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016529 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16530 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16531 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16532 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016533
16534 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16535 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016536 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016537
16538 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016539 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016540
16541 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016543
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016544 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016545 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16546
16547 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16548 binary or string samples.
16549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016550 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16551 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16554 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16555 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016557 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16558 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016560 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16561 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016563 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16564 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16567 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016568 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016570 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16571 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16572 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016573
16574For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16575request, it is possible to do :
16576
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016577 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016578
16579In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16580buffer, one would use the following acl :
16581
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016582 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016583
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016584On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16585possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16586
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016587 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016589All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16590criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16591method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010016592to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
16593usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
16594converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
16595method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
16596matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16598the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016600If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016601the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16602For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016604 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16605 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16606 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16607 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016608
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016609
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016610The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16611types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16612combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16613brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16614default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016616 +-------------------------------------------------+
16617 | Input sample type |
16618 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016619 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16621 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16622 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016623 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016624 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016625 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016626 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016627 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016628 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016629 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016630 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016631 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016632 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016633 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016635 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016636 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016637 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016638 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016639 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016640 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016641 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016642 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016643 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016644 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16645 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16646 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016647
16648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166497.1.1. Matching booleans
16650------------------------
16651
16652In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16653Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16654When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16655that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16656
16657Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16658return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16659"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166627.1.2. Matching integers
16663------------------------
16664
16665Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16666enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16667to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16668
16669Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16670matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16671lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016672
16673For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16674unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16675representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16676
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016677As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16678two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16679instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16680ranges and operators.
16681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016682For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016683operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16684Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16685of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016687Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016688
16689 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16690 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16691 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16692 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16693 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016695For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016696
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016697 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016698
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016699This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16700
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016701 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167047.1.3. Matching strings
16705-----------------------
16706
16707String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16708different forms :
16709
16710 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016711 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712
16713 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016714 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016715
16716 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16717 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16718
16719 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16720 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16721
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016722 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16723 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
16724 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
16725 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
16726 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
16727 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016728
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016729 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16730 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
16731 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
16732 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
16733 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
16734 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
16735 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
16736 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
16737 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
16738 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
16739 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016740
16741String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16742exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16743characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16744string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16745to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016746before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016747
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016748Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16749(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16750Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16751
16752Example:
16753 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16754 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167577.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16758---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016759
16760Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16761they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16762possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16763passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16764the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016765the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16766match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016767
16768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167697.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16770-------------------------------------
16771
16772It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16773not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16774a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16775to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16776digits may be used upper or lower case.
16777
16778Example :
16779 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016780 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016781
16782
167837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16784---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016785
16786IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16787netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16788within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016789host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016790difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16791at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16792does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16793parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016794
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016795The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16796abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16797
16798 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16799 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16800 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16801 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16802 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16803 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16804 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16805 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16806
16807Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16808192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16809
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016810IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16811Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16812trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16813IPv6 patterns.
16814
16815HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16816following situations :
16817 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16818 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16819 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16820 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16821 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16822 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16823 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16824 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16825 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16826 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828
168297.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16830----------------------------------
16831
16832Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16833combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16834
16835 - AND (implicit)
16836 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16837 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016839A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016841 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16844indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16847"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16848requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16849is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16850
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016851 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016852 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16853 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16854 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855
16856To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16857and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16858
16859 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16860 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16861 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16862 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016864 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16866 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16867 use_backend www if host_www
16868
16869It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16870expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16871be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16872the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16873
16874 The following rule :
16875
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016876 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016877 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878
16879 Can also be written that way :
16880
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016881 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882
16883It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16884to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16885simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16886sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16887good use is the following :
16888
16889 With named ACLs :
16890
16891 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16892 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16893 monitor fail if site_dead
16894
16895 With anonymous ACLs :
16896
16897 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16898
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016899See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16900keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016901
16902
169037.3. Fetching samples
16904---------------------
16905
16906Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16907against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16908sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16909ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16910of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16911available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16912
16913This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16914Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16915compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16916deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16917
16918The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16919matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16920method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16921indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16922
16923As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16924when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16925mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16926the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16927ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16928
16929Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16930multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16931when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016932incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16933are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016934is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16935all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16936
16937Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16938 - name
16939 - name(arg1)
16940 - name(arg1,arg2)
16941
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016942
169437.3.1. Converters
16944-----------------
16945
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016946Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16947of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16948is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16949was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016950has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016951unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16952
16953These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16954sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16955the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016956support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016957
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016958A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16959support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16960supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16961(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16962bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016965
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001696651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16967 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16968 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16969 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16970 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16971 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16972
16973 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016974 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16975 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016976 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16977 frontend http-in
16978 bind *:8081
16979 default_backend servers
16980 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16981 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16982
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016983add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016984 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016985 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016986 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16987 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016988 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016989 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16990 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16991 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16992 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016993 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016994 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016995
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020016996add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
16997 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
16998 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
16999 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17000 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17001 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17002 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17003 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17004 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17005 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17006 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17007 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17008 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17009 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17010 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17011 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17012 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17013 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017014 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17015 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017016
17017 Example:
17018 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17019 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17020 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17021 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17022
17023 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17024 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17025
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017026aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17027 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17028 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17029 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17030 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17031 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17032 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17033
17034 Example:
17035 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17036 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17037
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017038and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017039 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017040 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017041 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17042 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017043 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017044 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17045 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17046 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17047 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017048 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017049 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017050
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017051b64dec
17052 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17053 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017054 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17055 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017056
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017057base64
17058 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017059 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017060 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17061 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017062
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017063be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17064 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17065 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17066 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17067 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17068 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17069
17070 Example:
17071 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17072 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17073 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17074 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17075
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017076be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17077 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17078 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17079 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17080 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17081 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17082 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17083
17084 Example:
17085 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17086 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17087 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17088 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17089
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017090bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017091 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017092 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017093 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017094 presence of a flag).
17095
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017096bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17097 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17098 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017099 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017100
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017101concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17102 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17103 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17104 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17105 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17106 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17107 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17108 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17109 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17110 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17111 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017112 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017113 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017114 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017115 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17116 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17117 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017118
17119 Example:
17120 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17121 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17122 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017123 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017124 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017125 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17126
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017127cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017128 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17129 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017130
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017131crc32([<avalanche>])
17132 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17133 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17134 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17135 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17136 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17137 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17138 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17139 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17140 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17141 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017142 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17143
17144crc32c([<avalanche>])
17145 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17146 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17147 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17148 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17149 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17150 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17151 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17152 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017153
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017154cut_crlf
17155 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17156 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17157 updated.
17158
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017159da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017160 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17161 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17162 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17163 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017164 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017165 configuration language.
17166
17167 Example:
17168 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017169 bind *:8881
17170 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017171 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017172
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017173debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17174 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17175 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17176 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17177 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17178 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17179 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17180 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17181 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17182 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17183 printable sample types.
17184
17185 Example:
17186 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017187
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017188digest(<algorithm>)
17189 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17190 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17191
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017192 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017193 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17194
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017195div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017196 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17197 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017198 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017199 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17200 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017201 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017202 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17203 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17204 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17205 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017206 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017207 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017208
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017209djb2([<avalanche>])
17210 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17211 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17212 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17213 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17214 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17215 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17216 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017217 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17218 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017219
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017220even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017221 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017222 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17223
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017224field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17225 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17226 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17227 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17228 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17229 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17230 fields.
17231
17232 Example :
17233 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17234 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17235 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17236 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17237 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017238
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017239fix_is_valid
17240 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17241 Information eXchange):
17242
17243 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17244 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017245 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017246 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017247 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017248 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17249 checksum
17250
17251 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17252 the server can be parsed.
17253
17254 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17255 message, false if not.
17256
17257 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17258
17259 Example:
17260 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17261 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17262
17263fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17264 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17265 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17266 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17267 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017268 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017269 added.
17270
17271 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17272 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17273 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17274 fix_is_valid converter.
17275
17276 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17277
17278 Example:
17279 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17280 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17281 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17282 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17283 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17284
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017285hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017286 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017287 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017288 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017289 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017290
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017291hex2i
17292 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017293 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017294
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017295htonl
17296 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17297 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17298 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17299 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17300
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017301hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017302 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17303 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17304 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17305 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17306
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017307 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017308 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17309
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017310host_only
17311 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17312 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17313 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17314 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17315
17316 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17317
17318 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17319
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017320http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017321 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17322 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017323 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17324 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17325 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17326 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17327 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17328 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17329 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17330 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017332iif(<true>,<false>)
17333 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17334 string otherwise.
17335
17336 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017337 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017338
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017339in_table(<table>)
17340 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17341 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17342 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017343 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017344 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17345
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017346ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017347 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017348 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017349 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17350 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17351 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17352 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17353 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017354
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017355json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017356 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017357 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017358 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017359 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17360 of errors:
17361 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17362 bytes, ...)
17363 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17364 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17365
17366 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17367 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17368 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17369 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17370 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17371 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017372 - "ascii" : never fails;
17373 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17374 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017375 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017376 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017377 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17378 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17379
17380 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017381 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017382
17383 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017384 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017385 capture request header user-agent len 150
17386 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017387
17388 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17389 GET / HTTP/1.0
17390 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17391
17392 Output log:
17393 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17394
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017395json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17396 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17397 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17398 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17399 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17400
17401 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17402 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17403
17404 Example:
17405 # get a integer value from the request body
17406 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17407 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17408
17409 # get a key with '.' in the name
17410 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17411 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17412
17413 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17414 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17415
17416 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17417 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17418
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017419jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17420 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17421 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17422 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17423 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17424 json_path and output_type parameters.
17425
17426 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17427 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17428
17429jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17430 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17431 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17432 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17433 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17434 json_path and output_type parameters.
17435
17436 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17437 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17438
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017439jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17440 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17441 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017442 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017443 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17444 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17445 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17446 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017447
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017448 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17449 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17450 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17451 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017452
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017453 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17454 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17455 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17456 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17457 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17458 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017459 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017460 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17461
17462 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17463 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17464 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17465 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17466 contents.
17467
17468 The possible return values are the following :
17469
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017470 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17471 | ID | message |
17472 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017473 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017474 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017475 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17476 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17477 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17478 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17479 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017480 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017481
17482 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17483 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17484
17485 Example:
17486 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17487 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17488 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17489 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17490 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17491 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17492
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017493language(<value>[,<default>])
17494 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17495 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17496 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17497 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17498 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17499 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17500 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17501 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17502 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017503 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017504 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17505 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017507 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017508
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017509 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17510 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017512 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17513 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17514 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17515 use_backend spanish if es
17516 use_backend french if fr
17517 use_backend english if en
17518 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017519
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017520length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017521 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17522 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17523 type. The result is of type integer.
17524
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017525lower
17526 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17527 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17528 type. The result is of type string.
17529
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017530ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17531 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17532 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17533 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17534 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17535 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17536 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17537
17538 Example :
17539
17540 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017541 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017542 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17543
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017544ltrim(<chars>)
17545 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17546 representation of the input sample.
17547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017548map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17549map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17550map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17551 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17552 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17553 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17554 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17555 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17556 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17557 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17558 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017560 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17561 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17562 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017563
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017564 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017565 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017566
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017567 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17569 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017571 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017573 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17574 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17575 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17577 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17579 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017581 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17583 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17585 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17586 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17587 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17588 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017589
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017590 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17591 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17592 the corresponding match text.
17593
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017594 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17595 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17596 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17597 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17598 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017599
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017600 Example :
17601
17602 # this is a comment and is ignored
17603 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17604 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17605 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17606 | | | `---------- value
17607 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17608 | `---------------------------- key
17609 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17610
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017611mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017612 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17613 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017614 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017615 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17618 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17619 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17620 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017621 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017622 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017623
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017624mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017625 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17626 <packettype>.
17627 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17628 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17629 from.
17630 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17631 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17632 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17633
17634 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17635 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17636 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17637 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17638
17639 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17640 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17641 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17642 packets only):
17643 17: Session Expiry Interval
17644 33: Receive Maximum
17645 39: Maximum Packet Size
17646 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17647 25: Request Response Information
17648 23: Request Problem Information
17649 21: Authentication Method
17650 22: Authentication Data
17651 18: Will Delay Interval
17652 1: Payload Format Indicator
17653 2: Message Expiry Interval
17654 3: Content Type
17655 8: Response Topic
17656 9: Correlation Data
17657 Not supported yet:
17658 38: User Property
17659
17660 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17661 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17662 packets only):
17663 17: Session Expiry Interval
17664 33: Receive Maximum
17665 36: Maximum QoS
17666 37: Retain Available
17667 39: Maximum Packet Size
17668 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17669 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17670 31: Reason String
17671 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
17672 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
17673 42: Shared Subscription Available
17674 19: Server Keep Alive
17675 26: Response Information
17676 28: Server Reference
17677 21: Authentication Method
17678 22: Authentication Data
17679 Not supported yet:
17680 38: User Property
17681
17682 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17683 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17684 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17685 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17686
17687 Example:
17688
17689 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
17690 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17691 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
17692 if data_in_buffer
17693 # do the same as above
17694 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
17695 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
17696 if data_in_buffer
17697
17698mqtt_is_valid
17699 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
17700
17701 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17702 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
17703 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
17704 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
17705
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010017706 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
17707
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017708 Example:
17709
17710 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040017711 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017712
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017713mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017714 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020017715 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
17716 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017717 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017718 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017719 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017720 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17721 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17722 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17723 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017724 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017725 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017726
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010017727nbsrv
17728 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
17729 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
17730 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
17731 map lookup.
17732
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017733neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017734 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
17735 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
17736 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
17737 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017738
17739not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017740 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017741 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017742 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017743 absence of a flag).
17744
17745odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017746 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017747 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
17748
17749or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017750 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017751 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017752 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17753 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017754 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017755 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17756 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17757 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17758 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017759 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017760 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017761
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070017762param(<name>,[<delim>])
17763 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
17764 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
17765 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
17766 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
17767 a value of an empty string.
17768
17769 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
17770 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
17771 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
17772 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
17773
17774 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
17775 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
17776 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
17777 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
17778 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
17779 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
17780
17781 Example :
17782 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
17783 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
17784 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
17785 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
17786 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
17787
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017788port_only
17789 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
17790 returning its port.
17791 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17792 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17793 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17794
17795 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
17796
17797 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
17798
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017799protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17800 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17801 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17802 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17803 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17804 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17805 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17806 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17807 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17808 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17809 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17810 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17811
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017812regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017813 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17814 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17815 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17816 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17817 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17818 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17819 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17820 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17821 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017822 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17823 of characters with other ones.
17824
17825 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17826 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17827 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17828 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17829 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17830 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017831
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017832 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017833
17834 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17835 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17836 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017837 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017838
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017839 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17840 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17841
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017842 # capture groups and backreferences
17843 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017844 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017845 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17846
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017847capture-req(<id>)
17848 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17849 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17850
17851 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017852 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17853 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017854
17855capture-res(<id>)
17856 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17857 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17858
17859 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017860 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17861 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017862
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017863rtrim(<chars>)
17864 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17865 of the input sample.
17866
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017867sdbm([<avalanche>])
17868 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17869 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17870 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17871 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17872 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17873 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17874 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017875 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17876 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017877
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017878secure_memcmp(<var>)
17879 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17880 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17881 match.
17882
17883 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17884 performed in constant time.
17885
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017886 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017887 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17888
17889 Example :
17890
17891 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17892 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17893 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17894 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17895
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017896set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017897 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017898 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17899 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17900 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17901 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017902 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017903 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17904 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017905 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017906 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17907 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017908 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017909 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017910
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017911 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17912 possible conditions :
17913 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17914 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17915 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17916 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17917 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17918 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17919 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17920 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17921 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17922 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17923 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17924 called on the variable.
17925 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17926 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17927 configuration parsing.
17928 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17929 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17930 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17931 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17932 true by default.
17933
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017934sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017935 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017936 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17937
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017938sha2([<bits>])
17939 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17940 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17941
17942 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17943 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17944
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017945 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017946 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17947
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017948srv_queue
17949 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17950 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17951 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17952 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17953 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17954
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017955strcmp(<var>)
17956 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17957 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17958 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17959 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17960 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17961 shorter).
17962
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017963 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17964 strings in constant time.
17965
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017966 Example :
17967
17968 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17969 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17970 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17971
17972
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017973sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017974 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17975 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017976 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017977 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17978 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017979 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017980 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17981 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017982 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017983 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17984 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017985 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017986 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017987
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017988table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17989 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17990 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17991 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17992 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17993 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17994 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17995
17996
17997table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18001 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18002 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18003 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18004
18005table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18006 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18007 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018008 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018009 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18010 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18011
18012table_conn_cur(<table>)
18013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18016 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18017 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18018
18019table_conn_rate(<table>)
18020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18023 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18024 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18025
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018026table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18027 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18028 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18029 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18030 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18031 input sample in the designated table.
18032 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18033
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018034table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18037 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18038 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18039 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18040 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18041 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18042 data-type).
18043 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18044
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018045table_gpt0(<table>)
18046 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18047 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18048 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18049 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18050 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18051
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018052table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18053 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18054 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18055 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18056 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18057 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18058 between 0 and 99.
18059 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18060 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18061 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18062 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18063
18064table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18067 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18068 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18069 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18070 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18071 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18072 value 0.
18073 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18074 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18075 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18076
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018077table_gpc0(<table>)
18078 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18079 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18080 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18081 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18082 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18083
18084table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18085 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18086 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18087 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18088 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18089 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18090 sample fetch keyword.
18091
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018092table_gpc1(<table>)
18093 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18094 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18095 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18096 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18097 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18098
18099table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18100 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18101 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18102 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18103 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18104 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18105 sample fetch keyword.
18106
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018107table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18108 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18109 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018110 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018111 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18112 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18113
18114table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18117 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18118 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18119 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18120 keyword.
18121
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018122table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18125 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18126 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18127 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18128
18129table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18132 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18133 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18134 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18135 keyword.
18136
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018137table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18138 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18139 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018140 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018141 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18142 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18143
18144table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18145 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18146 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18147 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18148 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18149 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18150 keyword.
18151
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018152table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018153 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18154 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18155 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18156 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18157 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18158 updated.
18159 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18160
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018161table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18162 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18163 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018164 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018165 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18166 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18167 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18168 keyword.
18169
18170table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018174 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18175 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18176 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18177 keyword.
18178
18179table_server_id(<table>)
18180 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18181 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18182 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18183 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18184 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18185 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18186
18187table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18188 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18189 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018190 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018191 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18192 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18193 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18194 keyword.
18195
18196table_sess_rate(<table>)
18197 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18198 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18199 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18200 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18201 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18202 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18203 keyword.
18204
18205table_trackers(<table>)
18206 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18207 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18208 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18209 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18210 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18211 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18212 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18213 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18214 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18215 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18216
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018217ub64dec
18218 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18219 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18220 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18221
18222 Example:
18223 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18224 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18225
18226ub64enc
18227 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18228
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018229upper
18230 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18231 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18232 type. The result is of type string.
18233
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018234url_dec([<in_form>])
18235 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18236 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18237 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18238 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18239 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18240 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018241
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018242url_enc([<enc_type>])
18243 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18244 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18245 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18246 optional argument is here for future changes.
18247
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018248ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018249 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018250 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18251 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18252 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018253 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18254 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18255 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18256 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018257 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018258 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18259 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018260
18261 Example:
18262 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18263 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18264
18265 message Point {
18266 int32 latitude = 1;
18267 int32 longitude = 2;
18268 }
18269
18270 message PPoint {
18271 Point point = 59;
18272 }
18273
18274 message Rectangle {
18275 // One corner of the rectangle.
18276 PPoint lo = 48;
18277 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18278 PPoint hi = 49;
18279 }
18280
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018281 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18282 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18283 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018284
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018285 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18286 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018287 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018288 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18289
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018290 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018291
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018292 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018293
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018294 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18295 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18296 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018297
18298 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18299 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18300 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18301
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018302 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18303 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18304 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018305
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018306
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018307unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018308 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18309 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18310 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18311 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18312 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18313 response),
18314 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18315 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18316 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18317 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18318
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018319utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18320 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18321 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18322 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18323 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18324 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18325 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18326
18327 Example :
18328
18329 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018330 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018331 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18332
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018333word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18334 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18335 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18336 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018337 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018338 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18339 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18340
18341 Example :
18342 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18343 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18344 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18345 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18346 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018347 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018349wt6([<avalanche>])
18350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18358 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018360xor(<value>)
18361 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018362 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018363 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018364 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018365 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018366 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18367 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018368 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018369 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18370 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018371 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018372 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018373
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018374xxh3([<seed>])
18375 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18376 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18377 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18378 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18379 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18380 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18381 considered as cryptographically secure.
18382
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018383xxh32([<seed>])
18384 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18385 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18386 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18387 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18388 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18389 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18390 as cryptographically secure.
18391
18392xxh64([<seed>])
18393 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18394 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18395 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18396 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18397 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18398 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18399 as cryptographically secure.
18400
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018401x509_v_err_str
18402 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18403 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18404 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18405
18406 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18407 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18408 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18409
18410 Example:
18411
18412 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18413
18414 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18415 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18416 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18417
18418 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18419 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18420 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184227.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423--------------------------------------------
18424
18425A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18426not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18427"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18428The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18429
18430always_false : boolean
18431 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18432 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18433
18434always_true : boolean
18435 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18436 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18437
18438avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018439 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018440 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18441 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18442 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18443 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18444 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18445 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18446 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18447 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18448 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18449 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18450 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18451 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18452 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018454be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018455 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18456 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18457 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18458 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018459 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18460
18461be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18462 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18463 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18464 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18465 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18466 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018467 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18468 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018469
18470 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18471 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18472 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018474be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18475 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18476 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18477 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018478 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018479 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18480 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018481
18482 Example :
18483 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18484 backend dynamic
18485 mode http
18486 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18487 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018488
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018489bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018490 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18491 of the string.
18492
18493bool(<bool>) : bool
18494 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18495 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018497connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18498 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018499 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018500 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18501 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018502
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018503 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018504 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018505 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18506
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018507 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18508 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018509
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018510 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018511 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018512 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018513 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018514 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018515 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018516 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018517
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018518 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18519 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018521 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018522
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018523cpu_calls : integer
18524 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18525 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18526 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18527 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18528 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18529 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18530
18531cpu_ns_avg : integer
18532 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18533 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18534 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18535 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18536 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18537 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18538 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18539 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18540 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18541 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18542 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18543
18544cpu_ns_tot : integer
18545 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18546 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18547 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18548 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18549 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18550 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18551 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18552 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18553 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18554 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18555 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18556 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18557 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18558
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018559date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018560 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018561
18562 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18563 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18564 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018565 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18566
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018567 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18568 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18569 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18570 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18571 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18572
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018573 Example :
18574
18575 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18576 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018577
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018578 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18579 # millisecond granularity
18580 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18581
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018582date_us : integer
18583 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18584 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18585 from the same timeval structure.
18586
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018587env(<name>) : string
18588 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18589 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18590 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18591 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18592 certain way.
18593
18594 Examples :
18595 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18596 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18597
18598 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018599 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018601fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18602 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018603 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18604 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018605 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18606 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018607 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018608 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18609 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018610
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018611fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18612 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18613 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18614 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018616fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18618 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18619 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18620 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18621 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18622 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18623 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18624 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018625
18626 Example :
18627 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18628 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18629 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18630 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18631 frontend mail
18632 bind :25
18633 mode tcp
18634 maxconn 100
18635 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18636 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18637 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18638 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018639
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018640hostname : string
18641 Returns the system hostname.
18642
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018643int(<integer>) : signed integer
18644 Returns a signed integer.
18645
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018646ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18647 Returns an ipv4.
18648
18649ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18650 Returns an ipv6.
18651
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018652last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018653 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18654 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18655 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18656 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18657 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18658 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18659 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18660 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18661 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18662 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18663 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18664 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18665
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018666last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018667 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18668 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18669 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18670 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18671 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18672 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18673 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18674 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18675 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18676 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18677 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18678 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
18679
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018680lat_ns_avg : integer
18681 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18682 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18683 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18684 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18685 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18686 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18687 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18688 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18689 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018690 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18691 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18692 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18693 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18694 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
18695 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018696
18697lat_ns_tot : integer
18698 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
18699 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
18700 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
18701 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
18702 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
18703 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
18704 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
18705 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
18706 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020018707 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
18708 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
18709 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
18710 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
18711 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018712 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
18713 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
18714 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
18715 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
18716 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
18717 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
18718
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018719meth(<method>) : method
18720 Returns a method.
18721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018722nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
18723 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
18724 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
18725 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018726 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
18727 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
18728 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018729
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040018730prio_class : integer
18731 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
18732 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
18733 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
18734
18735prio_offset : integer
18736 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
18737 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
18738 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
18739 set-priority-offset".
18740
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018741proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020018742 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
18743 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018745queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018746 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
18747 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
18748 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018749 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
18750 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
18751 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
18752 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
18753 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
18754
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010018755rand([<range>]) : integer
18756 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
18757 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
18758 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
18759 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
18760 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
18761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018762srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18764 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
18765 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
18766 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
18767 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018768 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
18769 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
18770
18771srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18772 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18773 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
18774 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18775 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
18776 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
18777 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
18778 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
18779
18780 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
18781 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018782
18783srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
18784 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
18785 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
18786 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018787 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
18789 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
18790 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
18791
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020018792srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18793 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
18794 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
18795 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
18796 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
18797 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
18798 fetch methods.
18799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018800srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
18801 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18802 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018803 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
18805 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018806 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807 overloading servers).
18808
18809 Example :
18810 # Redirect to a separate back
18811 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
18812 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
18813 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
18814
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018815srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018816 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
18817 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
18818 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
18819
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018820srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018821 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
18822 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18823 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
18824
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018825srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018826 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18827 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18828 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18829
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018830stopping : boolean
18831 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18832 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18833 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18834
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018835str(<string>) : string
18836 Returns a string.
18837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18839 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18840 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18841
18842table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18843 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18844 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18845 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18846
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018847thread : integer
18848 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18849 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18850 and debugging purposes.
18851
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018852uuid([<version>]) : string
18853 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18854 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18855 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18856
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018857var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018858 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018859 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18860 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18861 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18864 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018865 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018866 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18867 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018868 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018869 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018870
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872----------------------------------
18873
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018874The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18876methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18877sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18878TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018879the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18880counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018881"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18882used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18883can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18884Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18885table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18886tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18887currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018888
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018889bc_dst : ip
18890 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18891 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18892 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18893 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18894
18895bc_dst_port : integer
18896 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018897 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018898
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018899bc_err : integer
18900 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18901 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18902 and their corresponding error message.
18903
18904bc_err_str : string
18905 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18906 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18907 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18908 corresponding error message.
18909
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018910bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018911 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18912 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18913 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18914
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018915bc_src : ip
18916 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018917 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018918 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18919 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18920
18921bc_src_port : integer
18922 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018923 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018925be_id : integer
18926 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018927 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18928 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018929
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018930be_name : string
18931 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018932 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18933 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018934
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018935be_server_timeout : integer
18936 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18937 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18938 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18939
18940be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18941 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18942 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18943 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18944
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018945cur_server_timeout : integer
18946 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18947 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18948 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18949
18950cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18951 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18952 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18953 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018955dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018956 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18957 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18958 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18959 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18960 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18961 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18962 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18963 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18964 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18965 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18966 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018967
18968dst_conn : integer
18969 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18970 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18971 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18972 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18973 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18974 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18975 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18976 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018977
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018978dst_is_local : boolean
18979 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18980 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18981 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18982 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018983 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018984 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18985 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18986 it only once per connection.
18987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988dst_port : integer
18989 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18990 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018991 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18992 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18993 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18994 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018995
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018996fc_dst : ip
18997 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18998 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18999 for details.
19000
19001fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19002 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19003 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19004 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19005
19006fc_dst_port : integer
19007 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19008 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19009 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19010
19011fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019012 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19013 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19014 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019015 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019016 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19017
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019018fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019019 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019020 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019021 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019022 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19023
19024 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19025 | ID | message |
19026 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19027 | 0 | "Success" |
19028 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19029 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19030 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19031 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19032 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19033 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19034 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19035 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19036 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19037 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19038 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19039 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19040 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19041 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19042 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19043 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19044 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19045 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19046 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19047 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19048 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19049 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19050 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19051 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19052 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19053 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19054 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19055 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19056 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19057 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19058 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19059 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19060 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19061 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19062 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19063 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19064 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19065 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19066 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19067 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19068 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19069 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019070 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019071 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19072
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019073fc_fackets : integer
19074 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19075 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19076 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19077 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19078
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019079fc_http_major : integer
19080 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19081 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19082 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19083
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019084fc_lost : integer
19085 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19086 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19087 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19088 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19089
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019090fc_pp_authority : string
19091 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19092 if any.
19093
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019094fc_pp_unique_id : string
19095 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19096 if any.
19097
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019098fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19099 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19100 header.
19101
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019102fc_reordering : integer
19103 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19104 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19105 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19106 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19107
19108fc_retrans : integer
19109 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19110 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19111 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19112 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19113
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019114fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19115 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19116 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19117 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19118 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19119 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19120 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19121
19122fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19123 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19124 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19125 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19126 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19127 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19128 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19129
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019130fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019131 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19132 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19133 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19134 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19135
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019136fc_src : ip
19137 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19138 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19139 for details.
19140
19141fc_src_is_local : boolean
19142 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19143 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19144 "src_is_local" for details.
19145
19146fc_src_port : integer
19147
19148 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19149 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19150 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19151
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019152
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019153fc_unacked : integer
19154 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19155 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19156 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19157 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019158
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019159fe_defbe : string
19160 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19161 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019163fe_id : integer
19164 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019165 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019166 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19167
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019168fe_name : string
19169 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19170 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19171 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19172
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019173fe_client_timeout : integer
19174 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19175 current frontend.
19176
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019177sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019178sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19179sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19180sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019181 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19182 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19183 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19184
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019185sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019186sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19187sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19188sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019189 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19190 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19191 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19192
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019193sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19194 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19195 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19196 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19197 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19198 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19199 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19200 will always return zero.
19201 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19202 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19203
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019204sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019205sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19206sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19207sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019208 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19209 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019210 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19211 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19212 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019213
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019214 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019215 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19216 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019217 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19218 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19219 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019220 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19221 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19222
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019223sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19224sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19225sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19226sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19227 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19228 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19229 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19230 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19231 when a first ACL was verified.
19232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019233sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019234sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19235sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19236sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019237 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019238 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19239
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019240sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019241sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19242sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19243sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019244 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19245 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19246 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19247
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019248sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019249sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19250sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19251sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019252 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19253 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19254 See also src_conn_rate.
19255
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019256sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19257 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19258 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19259 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19260 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19261 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19262 index, zero is returned.
19263 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19264 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19265
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019266sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019267sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19268sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19269sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019270 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019271 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019272
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019273sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19274sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19275sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19276sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19277 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19278 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19279
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019280sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19281 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19282 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19283 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19284 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19285 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19286 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19287 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19288
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019289sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19290sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19291sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19292sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19293 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19294 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19295
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019296sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19297 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19298 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19299 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19300 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19301 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19302 between 0 and 2.
19303 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19304 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19305 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19306 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19307 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019309sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019310sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19311sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19312sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019313 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19314 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19315 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019316 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19317 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19318 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019319
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019320sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19321sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19322sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19323sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19324 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19325 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19326 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19327 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19328 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19329 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19330
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019331sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019332sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19333sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19334sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019335 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019336 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19337 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19338
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019339sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019340sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19341sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19342sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019343 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19344 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19345 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19346 src_http_err_rate.
19347
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019348sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19349sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19350sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19351sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19352 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19353 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19354 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19355
19356sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19357sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19358sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19359sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19360 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19361 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19362 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19363 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19364
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019365sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019366sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19367sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19368sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019369 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019370 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19371 src_http_req_cnt.
19372
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019373sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019374sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19375sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19376sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019377 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19378 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19379 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19380 src_http_req_rate.
19381
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019382sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19383 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19384 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19385 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19386 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19387 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19388 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19389 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19390 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19391 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19392
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019393sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019394sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19395sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19396sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019397 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019398 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19399 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19400 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19401 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019402
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019403 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019404 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19405 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019406 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19407
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019408sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19409sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19410sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19411sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19412 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19413 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19414 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19415 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19416 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19417
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019418sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019419sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19420sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19421sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019422 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19423 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19424 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019425
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019426sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019427sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19428sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19429sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019430 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19431 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19432 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019433
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019434sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019435sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19436sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19437sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019438 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019439 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19440 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19441 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019442 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019443 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19444
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019445sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019446sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19447sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19448sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019449 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19450 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19451 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19452 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19453 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019454 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019455
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019456sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019457sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19458sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19459sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019460 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19461 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19462 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19463
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019464sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019465sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19466sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19467sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019468 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19469 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019470 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019471 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19472 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019473 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19474 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19475 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019477so_id : integer
19478 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19479 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19480 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019481
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019482so_name : string
19483 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19484 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19485 strings instead of integers.
19486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019487src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019488 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19489 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19490 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19491 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19492 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19493 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19494 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19495 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19496 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19497 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19498 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19499 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19500 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19501 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19502 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019503
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019504 Example:
19505 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19506 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19509 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19510 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19511 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019512 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019514src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19515 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19516 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019517 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019518 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019519
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019520src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19521 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19522 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19523 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19524 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19525 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19526 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19527 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19528 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019530src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19531 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19532 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19533 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19534 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19535 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19536 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019537
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019538 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019539 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19540 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19541 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19542 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019543 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019544 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19545 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19546
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019547src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19548 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19549 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19550 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19551 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19552 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19553 was verified.
19554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019555src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019556 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019557 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019558 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019559 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019562 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019563 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19564 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019565 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019567src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19568 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19569 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19570 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019571 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019572
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019573src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19574 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19575 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19576 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19577 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19578 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19579 is returned.
19580 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19581 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19582 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019584src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019585 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019586 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019587 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019588 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019589
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019590src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19591 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19592 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19593 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19594 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19595
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019596src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19597 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19598 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19599 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19600 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19601 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19602 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19603
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019604src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19605 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19606 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19607 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19608 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19609
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019610src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19611 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19612 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19613 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19614 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19615 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19616 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19617 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19618 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19619 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19620 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019622src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019623 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019624 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019625 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19626 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019627 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19628 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19629 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019630
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019631src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19632 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19633 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19634 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19635 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19636 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19637 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19638 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019640src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019641 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019642 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019643 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019644 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019645 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19648 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19649 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19650 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19651 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019652 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019653
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019654src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19655 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19656 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019657 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019658 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19659 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19660
19661src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19662 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19663 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19664 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
19665 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
19666 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
19667 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
19668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019670 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19672 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019673 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019675src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19676 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
19677 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
19678 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019679 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019680 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019681
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019682src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19683 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
19684 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19685 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
19686 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19687 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
19688 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19689 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19690 See also sc_inc_gpc.
19691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019692src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19693 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19694 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19695 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019696 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019697 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19698 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019699
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019700 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019701 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019702 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019703 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019704
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019705src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19706 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19707 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19708 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
19709 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19710 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
19711 connection when a first ACL was verified.
19712
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019713src_is_local : boolean
19714 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
19715 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
19716 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
19717 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019718 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019719 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
19720 once per connection.
19721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019722src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019723 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
19724 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19725 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
19726 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
19727 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019729src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019730 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
19731 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19732 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
19733 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
19734 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019736src_port : integer
19737 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019738 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
19739 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
19740 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
19741 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019743src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019744 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019745 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19746 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
19747 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019748 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019750src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19751 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
19752 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19753 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19754 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019755 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019757src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19758 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
19759 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
19760 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
19761 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
19762 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
19763 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
19764 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
19765 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019766
19767 Example :
19768 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
19769 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
19770 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
19771 listen ssh
19772 bind :22
19773 mode tcp
19774 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019775 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019776 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020019777 server local 127.0.0.1:22
19778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019779srv_id : integer
19780 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
19781 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019782 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020019783
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019784srv_name : string
19785 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
19786 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019787 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080019788
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200197897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019790----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020019791
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019792The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
19794when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
19795usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019796future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019797
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001979851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
19799 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
19800 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
19801 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
19802 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
19803 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
19804
19805 Example :
19806 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
19807 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
19808 # the request.
19809 frontend http-in
19810 bind *:8081
19811 default_backend servers
19812 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
19813 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
19814
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019815ssl_bc : boolean
19816 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19817 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019818 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19819 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019820
19821ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
19822 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019823 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19824 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019825
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019826ssl_bc_alpn : string
19827 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19828 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019829 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019830 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19831 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19832 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19833 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19834 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019835 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19836 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019837
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019838ssl_bc_cipher : string
19839 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019840 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19841 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019842
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019843ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19844 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19845 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19846 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019847 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019848
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019849ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019850 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019851 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19852 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19853 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19854 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019855 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19856 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19857 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19858
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019859ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019860 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019861 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19862 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19863 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019864
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019865ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19866 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19867 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019868 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19869 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019870
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019871ssl_bc_npn : string
19872 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19873 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019874 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019875 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19876 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19877 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19878 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019879 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19880 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019881
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019882ssl_bc_protocol : string
19883 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019884 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19885 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019886
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019887ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019888 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019889 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019890 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19891 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019892
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019893ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19894 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19895 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19896 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019897 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019898
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019899ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19900 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19901 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019902 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19903 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019904
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019905ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19906 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19907 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19908 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019909 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019910
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019911ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19912 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019913 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19914 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019916ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19917 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19918 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19919 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19920 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19921 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019923ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19924 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19925 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19926 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19927 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019928
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019929ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019930 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19931 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19932 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019933 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019934 does not support resumed sessions.
19935
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019936ssl_c_der : binary
19937 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19938 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19939 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019941ssl_c_err : integer
19942 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19943 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19944 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19945 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19946 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019947
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019948ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019949 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19950 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19951 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19952 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19953 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19954 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19955 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19956 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019957 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19958 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19959 LDAP v3.
19960 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19961 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019963ssl_c_key_alg : string
19964 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19965 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19966 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968ssl_c_notafter : string
19969 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19970 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19971 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019973ssl_c_notbefore : string
19974 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19975 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19976 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019977
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019978ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019979 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19980 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19981 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19982 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19983 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19984 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19985 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19986 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019987 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19988 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19989 LDAP v3.
19990 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19991 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019993ssl_c_serial : binary
19994 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19995 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19996 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019998ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19999 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20000 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20001 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020002 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20003 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20004
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020005 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020006 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020008ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20009 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20010 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20011 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020013ssl_c_used : boolean
20014 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20015 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020017ssl_c_verify : integer
20018 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20019 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20020 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20021 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020023ssl_c_version : integer
20024 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20025 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020026
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020027ssl_f_der : binary
20028 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20029 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20030 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20031
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020032ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020033 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20034 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20035 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20036 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020037 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020038 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20039 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20040 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020041 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20042 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20043 LDAP v3.
20044 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20045 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020047ssl_f_key_alg : string
20048 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20049 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20050 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020052ssl_f_notafter : string
20053 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20054 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20055 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020057ssl_f_notbefore : string
20058 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20059 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20060 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020061
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020062ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020063 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20064 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20065 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20066 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20067 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20068 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20069 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20070 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020071 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20072 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20073 LDAP v3.
20074 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20075 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020077ssl_f_serial : binary
20078 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20079 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20080 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020081
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020082ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20083 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20084 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20085 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020087ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20088 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20089 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20090 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020092ssl_f_version : integer
20093 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20094 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20095
20096ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020097 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20098 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20099 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020101 Example :
20102 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20103 listen http-https
20104 bind :80
20105 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20106 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20107
20108ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20109 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20110 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20111
20112ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020113 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020114 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020115 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020116 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20117 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20118 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20119 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20120 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20121 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020123ssl_fc_cipher : string
20124 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20125 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020126
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020127ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20128 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20129 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020130 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020131 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20132 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20133 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020134
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020135 Example:
20136 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20137 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20138 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20139 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20140 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20141 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20142 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20143 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20144 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20145
20146ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020147 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020148 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020149 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20150 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020151 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20152 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020153
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020154ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020155 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020156 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020157 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020158 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20159 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20160 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20161 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20162 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20163 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020164
20165ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020166 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020167 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20168 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020169
20170ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20171 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20172 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020173 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020174
20175 Example:
20176 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20177 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20178 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20179 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20180 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20181 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20182 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20183 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20184 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20185
20186ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20187 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20188 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020189 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020190 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20191 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20192 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20193
20194 Example:
20195 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20196 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20197 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20198 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20199 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20200 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20201 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20202 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20203 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20204
20205ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20206 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20207 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020208 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020209 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20210 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20211 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20212
20213 Example:
20214 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20215 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20216 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20217 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20218 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20219 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20220 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20221 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20222 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020223
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020224ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20225 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20226 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20227 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20228
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020229ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20230 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20231 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20232 transport layer.
20233 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20234 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20235 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20236 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20237
20238ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20239 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20240 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20241 transport layer.
20242 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20243 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20244 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20245 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20246
20247ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20248 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20249 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20250 transport layer.
20251 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20252 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20253 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20254 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20255
20256ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20257 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20258 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20259 transport layer.
20260 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20261 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20262 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20263 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20264
20265ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20266 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20267 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20268 transport layer.
20269 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20270 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20271 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20272 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20273
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020274ssl_fc_err : integer
20275 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20276 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20277 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20278 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20279 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20280 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20281 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20282 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20283 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20284 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20285 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20286 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20287 codes.
20288
20289ssl_fc_err_str : string
20290 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20291 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20292 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20293 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20294 also "ssl_fc_err".
20295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020296ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020297 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20298 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020299 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20300 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20301 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20302 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020303
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020304ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20305 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20306 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20307 wait until the handshake happened.
20308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020309ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20310 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020311 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20312 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020313 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020314 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020315
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020316ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020317 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020318 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20319 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020321ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020322 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020323 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020324 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20325 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20326 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20327 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20328 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20329 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020331ssl_fc_protocol : string
20332 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20333 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020334
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020335ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20336 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20337 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020338 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20339 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020340
20341 Example:
20342 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20343 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20344 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20345 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20346 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20347 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20348 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20349 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20350 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20351
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020352ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020353 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020354 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020355 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020356
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020357ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20358 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20359 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20360 transport layer.
20361 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20362 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20363 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20364 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20365
20366ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20367 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20368 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20369 transport layer.
20370 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20371 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20372 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20373 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20374
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020375ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20376 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20377 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20378 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020380ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20381 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20382 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20383 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20384 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020385
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020386ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20387 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20388 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20389 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20390 BoringSSL.
20391
20392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020393ssl_fc_sni : string
20394 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20395 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020396 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020397 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20398 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20399
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020400 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020401 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020402 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020403 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020404 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020405
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020406 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20407 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20408 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20409 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20410 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20411 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20412 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20413 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20414 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020416 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020417 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20418 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020420ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20421 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20422 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020423
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020424ssl_s_der : binary
20425 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20426 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20427 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20428
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020429ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20430 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20431 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20432 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020433 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020434 does not support resumed sessions.
20435
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020436ssl_s_key_alg : string
20437 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20438 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20439 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20440
20441ssl_s_notafter : string
20442 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20443 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20444 transport layer.
20445
20446ssl_s_notbefore : string
20447 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20448 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20449 transport layer.
20450
20451ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20452 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20453 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20454 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20455 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20456 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20457 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020458 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20459 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020460 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20461 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20462 LDAP v3.
20463 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20464 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20465
20466ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20467 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20468 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20469 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20470 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20471 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20472 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020473 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20474 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020475 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20476 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20477 LDAP v3.
20478 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20479 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20480
20481ssl_s_serial : binary
20482 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20483 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20484 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20485
20486ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20487 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20488 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20489 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20490
20491ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20492 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20493 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20494 layer.
20495
20496ssl_s_version : integer
20497 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20498 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020499
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200205007.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020501------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020503Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20504sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20505only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20506For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20507be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20508can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20509sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20510for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20511content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020512
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020513Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20514 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020515 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020516 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20517 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20518 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20519 sample expression). So be careful.
20520
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020521distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20522 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20523 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20524 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20525 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20526 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20527 list of supported tokens.
20528
20529distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20530 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20531 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20532 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20533 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20534 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20535 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20536 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20537 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20538 supported tokens.
20539
20540 Example :
20541 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20542 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20543 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20544 # send large files to the big farm
20545 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020547payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020548 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020549 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20550 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020552payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20553 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020554 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020555 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020557req.len : integer
20558req_len : integer (deprecated)
20559 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20560 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20561 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20562 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20563 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020564 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020565 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20566 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020568req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20569 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020570 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20571 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20572 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20573 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020574
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020575 ACL derivatives :
20576 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020578req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20579 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20580 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20581 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20582 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020583
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020584 ACL derivatives :
20585 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020587 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020589req.proto_http : boolean
20590req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20591 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20592 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20593 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20594 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20595 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20596 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20597 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020599 Example:
20600 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20601 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20602 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020603 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020605req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20606rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20607 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20608 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20609 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20610 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20611 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20612 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20613 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020615 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20616 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20617 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20618 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20619 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20620 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020622 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020623 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020625 Example :
20626 listen tse-farm
20627 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20628 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20629 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20630 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20631 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20632 persist rdp-cookie
20633 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20634 # This is only useful makes sense if
20635 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20636 stick-table type string size 204800
20637 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20638 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20639 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020641 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020642 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020644req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20645rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20646 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20647 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20648 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20649 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020651 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020652 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020653
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020654req.ssl_alpn : string
20655 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20656 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20657 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20658 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20659 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20660 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020661 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020662
20663 Examples :
20664 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20665 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020666 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020667 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020668 default_backend bk_default
20669
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020670req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
20671 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
20672 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020020673 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
20674 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
20675 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
20676 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
20677 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020020678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020679req.ssl_hello_type : integer
20680req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20681 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20682 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
20683 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20684 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20685 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
20686 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20687 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020689req.ssl_sni : string
20690req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
20691 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
20692 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
20693 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
20694 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20695 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020020696 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
20697 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
20698 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
20699 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
20700 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
20701 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
20702 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
20703 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
20704 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020706 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020707 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020709 Examples :
20710 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
20711 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020712 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020713 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020714 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020715
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053020716req.ssl_st_ext : integer
20717 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
20718 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
20719 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
20720 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
20721 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
20722 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
20723 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
20724 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
20725 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
20726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020727req.ssl_ver : integer
20728req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
20729 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
20730 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
20731 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
20732 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
20733 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
20734 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
20735 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020736 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020737 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020739 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020740 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020741
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020742res.len : integer
20743 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20744 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20745 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20746 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20747 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020748 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020749 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020750 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020020751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020752res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20753 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020754 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020755 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020756 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020757 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020759res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20760 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20761 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20762 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020763 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
20764 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020766 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020767
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020020768res.ssl_hello_type : integer
20769rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
20770 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
20771 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
20772 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
20773 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
20774 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
20775 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
20776 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
20777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020778wait_end : boolean
20779 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
20780 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020781 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020782 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
20783 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020784 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020785 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
20786 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020788 Examples :
20789 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
20790 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
20791 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020793 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
20794 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20795 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
20796 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
20797 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
20798 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
20799 tcp-request content reject
20800
20801
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208027.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020803--------------------------------------
20804
20805It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
20806This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
20807data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
20808its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
20809HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
20810content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
20811to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
20812more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
20813response are indexed.
20814
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010020815Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
20816 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
20817 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
20818 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
20819 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
20820 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
20821 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
20822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020823base : string
20824 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20825 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
20826 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
20827 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
20828 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
20829 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
20830 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
20831 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
20832
20833 ACL derivatives :
20834 base : exact string match
20835 base_beg : prefix match
20836 base_dir : subdir match
20837 base_dom : domain match
20838 base_end : suffix match
20839 base_len : length match
20840 base_reg : regex match
20841 base_sub : substring match
20842
20843base32 : integer
20844 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
20845 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
20846 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020020847 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
20848 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
20849 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020850
20851base32+src : binary
20852 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
20853 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
20854 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
20855 per-URL counters.
20856
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010020857baseq : string
20858 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
20859 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
20860 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20861 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20862
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020863capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20864 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20865 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20866 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20867
20868capture.req.method : string
20869 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20870 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20871 because it's allocated.
20872
20873capture.req.uri : string
20874 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20875 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20876 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20877 allocated.
20878
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020879capture.req.ver : string
20880 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20881 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20882 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20883
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020884capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20885 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20886 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20887 The first entry is an index of 0.
20888 See also: "capture response header"
20889
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020890capture.res.ver : string
20891 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20892 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20893 persistent flag.
20894
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020895req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020896 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20897 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20898 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020899
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020900req.body_param([<name>) : string
20901 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20902 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20903 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20904 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20905 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20906 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20907 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20908 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20909 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20910 given.
20911
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020912req.body_len : integer
20913 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20914 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020915 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20916 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020917
20918req.body_size : integer
20919 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020920 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20921 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020923req.cook([<name>]) : string
20924cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20925 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20926 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20927 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20928 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20929 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20930 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20931 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20932 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20933
20934 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020935 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20936 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20937 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20938 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20939 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20940 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20941 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20942 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020944req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20945cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20946 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20947 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020949req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20950cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20951 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20952 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20953 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20954 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020956cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20957 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20958 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20959 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20960 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020961 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020962 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20963 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20964 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20965 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020967hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20968 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20969 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20970 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20971 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020972 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020974req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020975 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20976 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20977 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20978 with headers such as User-Agent.
20979
20980 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20981 found.
20982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020983 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20984 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20985 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020986 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020988req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20989 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20990 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020991 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20992 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020994req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020995 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20996 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20997 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20998 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20999 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21000 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21001 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21002
21003 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21004 found.
21005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021006 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21007 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21008 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021009 with -1 being the last one.
21010
21011 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21012 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021014 ACL derivatives :
21015 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21016 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21017 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21018 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21019 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21020 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21021 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21022 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21023
21024req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21025hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21026 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21027 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021028 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21029 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21030 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21031
21032 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21033 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21034 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21035
21036 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021037
21038req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21039hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21040 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21041 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21042 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021043 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21044 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21045 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21046 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21047 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021048
21049 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21050
21051 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021052
21053req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21054hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21055 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21056 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21057 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021058
21059 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21060
21061 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021062
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021063req.hdrs : string
21064 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21065 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21066 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21067 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21068
21069req.hdrs_bin : binary
21070 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21071 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21072 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21073 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21074 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21075 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21076
21077 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021078
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021079 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21080 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021082http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21083 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21084 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21085 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21086 basic auth is supported.
21087
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021088http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21089 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21090 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21091 performed on the data sent by the client.
21092 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21093 Authorization one.
21094
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021095http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21096 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21097 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21098 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21099 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021100 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21101 basic auth is supported.
21102
21103 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021104 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21105 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21106 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21107 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021108
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021109http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021110 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21111 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21112 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021113
21114http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021115 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21116 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21117 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021118
21119http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021120 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21121 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21122 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021124http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021125 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21126 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021127 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21128 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021130method : integer + string
21131 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21132 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21133 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21134 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21135 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21136 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21137 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021139 ACL derivatives :
21140 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021142 Example :
21143 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21144 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21145 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021147path : string
21148 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21149 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21150 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21151 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21152 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021153 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021154 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021156 ACL derivatives :
21157 path : exact string match
21158 path_beg : prefix match
21159 path_dir : subdir match
21160 path_dom : domain match
21161 path_end : suffix match
21162 path_len : length match
21163 path_reg : regex match
21164 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021165
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021166pathq : string
21167 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21168 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21169 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21170 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21171 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21172 result in both cases.
21173
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021174query : string
21175 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21176 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21177 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21178 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021179 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021180 which stops before the question mark.
21181
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021182req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21183 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21184 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21185 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21186 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021188req.ver : string
21189req_ver : string (deprecated)
21190 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21191 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21192 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021194 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021195 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021196
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021197res.body : binary
21198 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21199 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021200 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21201
21202 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021203
21204res.body_len : integer
21205 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21206 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021207 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21208
21209 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021210
21211res.body_size : integer
21212 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21213 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21214 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21215 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021216 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21217
21218 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021219
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021220res.cache_hit : boolean
21221 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21222 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21223
21224res.cache_name : string
21225 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21226 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21227 empty string.
21228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021229res.comp : boolean
21230 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21231 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21232 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021234res.comp_algo : string
21235 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21236 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21237 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021239res.cook([<name>]) : string
21240scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21241 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21242 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021243 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21244
21245 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021247 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021248 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021250res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21251scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21252 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21253 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021254 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21255
21256 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021258res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21259scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21260 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21261 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021262 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21263
21264 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021266res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021267 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21268 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21269
21270 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21271 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21272
21273 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21274
21275 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021277res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021278 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21279 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21280
21281 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21282 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21283
21284 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021286res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21287shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021288 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21289 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21290
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021291 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021292 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21293
21294 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021296 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021297 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21298 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21299 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21300 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21301 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21302 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21303 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21304 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021305
21306res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21307shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021308 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21309 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21310
21311 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021312 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021313
21314 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021316res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21317shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021318 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21319 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21320
21321 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21322
21323 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021324
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021325res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21326 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21327 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21328 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021329 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21330
21331 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021333res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21334shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021335 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21336 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21337
21338 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21339
21340 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021341
21342res.hdrs : string
21343 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21344 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21345 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021346 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21347
21348 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021349
21350res.hdrs_bin : binary
21351 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21352 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21353 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21354 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21355 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21356 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21357 (length of 0 for both).
21358
21359 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21360
21361 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21362 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021364res.ver : string
21365resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21366 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021367 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21368
21369 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021371 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021372 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021374set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21375 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21376 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021377 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021378 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021380 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21381 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021383status : integer
21384 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21385 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021386 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21387
21388 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021389
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021390unique-id : string
21391 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21392 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21393 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21394 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21395 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21396 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021398url : string
21399 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21400 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21401 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21402 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21403 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21404 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21405 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021407 ACL derivatives :
21408 url : exact string match
21409 url_beg : prefix match
21410 url_dir : subdir match
21411 url_dom : domain match
21412 url_end : suffix match
21413 url_len : length match
21414 url_reg : regex match
21415 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021417url_ip : ip
21418 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21419 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21420 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21421 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021422 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21423 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021425url_port : integer
21426 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021427 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021428
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021429urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21430url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021431 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21432 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021433 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21434 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21435 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21436 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021437 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21438 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021439 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21440 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021442 ACL derivatives :
21443 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21444 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21445 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21446 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21447 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21448 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21449 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21450 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021451
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021453 Example :
21454 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21455 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21456 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21457 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021458
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021459urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021460 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21461 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21462 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021463
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021464url32 : integer
21465 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21466 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21467 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21468 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21469 is an unsigned integer.
21470
21471url32+src : binary
21472 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21473 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21474 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21475
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021476
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200214777.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021478---------------------------------------
21479
21480This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21481used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21482purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21483There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21484or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21485any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21486for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21487
21488internal.htx.data : integer
21489 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21490 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21491
21492internal.htx.free : integer
21493 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21494 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21495
21496internal.htx.free_data : integer
21497 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21498 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21499
21500internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021501 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21502 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21503 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021504
21505internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21506 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21507 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21508
21509internal.htx.size : integer
21510 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21511 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21512
21513internal.htx.used : integer
21514 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21515 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21516 direction.
21517
21518internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21519 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21520 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21521 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21522 of the special value :
21523 * head : The oldest inserted block
21524 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021525 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021526
21527internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21528 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21529 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21530 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21531 integer or one of the special value :
21532 * head : The oldest inserted block
21533 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021534 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021535
21536internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21537 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21538 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21539 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21540 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21541
21542 * head : The oldest inserted block
21543 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021544 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021545
21546internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21547 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21548 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21549 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21550 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21551
21552 * head : The oldest inserted block
21553 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021554 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021555
21556internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21557 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21558 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21559 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21560 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21561
21562 * head : The oldest inserted block
21563 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021564 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021565
21566internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21567 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21568 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21569 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21570 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21571
21572 * head : The oldest inserted block
21573 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021574 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021575
21576internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21577 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21578 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21579 it returns false.
21580
21581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200215827.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021583---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021584
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021585Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21586every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021587order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021589ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021590---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21591FALSE always_false never match
21592HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21593HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21594HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021595HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021596HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21597HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21598HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21599HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021600LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021601METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21602METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21603METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21604METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21605METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21606METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21607METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21608METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21609RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21610REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21611TRUE always_true always match
21612WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21613---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021614
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216168. Logging
21617----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021618
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021619One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21620provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21621very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21622provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21623state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021624to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021625headers.
21626
21627In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21628about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21629send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21630
21631 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21632 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21633 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21634 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21635 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021636 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021637 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021638
21639The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21640allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21641as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21642while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21643real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21644delay.
21645
21646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216478.1. Log levels
21648---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021649
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021650TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021651source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021652HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21653in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21654track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21655syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21656about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021657
21658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216598.2. Log formats
21660----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021661
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021662HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021663and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
21664slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
21665options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021666
21667 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
21668 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
21669 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
21670 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
21671 extents.
21672
21673 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
21674 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
21675 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
21676 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
21677 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
21678
21679 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
21680 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
21681 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
21682 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
21683 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
21684
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020021685 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
21686 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
21687 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
21688 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
21689
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021690 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
21691
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021692Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
21693specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
21694field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
21695servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
21696always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
21697identifier.
21698
21699Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
21700 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
21701 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
21702 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
21703 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
21704
21705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217068.2.1. Default log format
21707-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021708
21709This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
21710as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
21711format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
21712
21713 Example :
21714 listen www
21715 mode http
21716 log global
21717 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21718
21719 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
21720 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
21721 (www/HTTP)
21722
21723 Field Format Extract from the example above
21724 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
21725 2 'Connect from' Connect from
21726 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
21727 4 'to' to
21728 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
21729 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
21730
21731Detailed fields description :
21732 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
21733 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
21734 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
21735 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
21736 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21737 and processed the connection.
21738 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
21739
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021740In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
21741"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
21742connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
21743
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021744It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
21745will eventually disappear.
21746
21747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200217488.2.2. TCP log format
21749---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021750
21751The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
21752is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
21753information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
21754counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
21755emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
21756environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
21757the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
21758sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021759specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021760not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21761
21762The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21763exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010021764if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
21765Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021766
21767 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
21768 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21769 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010021770 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
21771 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021772
21773A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
21774are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021775
21776 Example :
21777 frontend fnt
21778 mode tcp
21779 option tcplog
21780 log global
21781 default_backend bck
21782
21783 backend bck
21784 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21785
21786 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
21787 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
21788 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
21789
21790 Field Format Extract from the example above
21791 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
21792 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
21793 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
21794 4 frontend_name fnt
21795 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
21796 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
21797 7 bytes_read* 212
21798 8 termination_state --
21799 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
21800 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21801
21802Detailed fields description :
21803 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021804 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021805 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21806 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021807 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021808 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021809 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021810
21811 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021812 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21813 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21814 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021815
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021816 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021817 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
21818 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021819 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
21820 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
21821 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
21822 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021823
21824 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21825 and processed the connection.
21826
21827 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21828 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21829 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
21830 applications.
21831
21832 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21833 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21834 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21835 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
21836 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
21837
21838 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21839 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
21840 See "Timers" below for more details.
21841
21842 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21843 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
21844 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
21845 "Timers" below for more details.
21846
21847 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021848 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021849 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
21850 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
21851 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
21852 details.
21853
21854 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
21855 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
21856 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
21857 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
21858 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
21859
21860 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21861 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21862 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
21863 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21864 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21865 for more details.
21866
21867 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021868 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021869 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21870 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21871 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021872 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021873
21874 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21875 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21876 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21877 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21878 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21879 caused by a denial of service attack.
21880
21881 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21882 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21883 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21884 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21885 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21886 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21887 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21888 denial of service attack.
21889
21890 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21891 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21892 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21893 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21894 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21895 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21896 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21897 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21898 be processed than on other servers.
21899
21900 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21901 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21902 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21903 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021904 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021905 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21906 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21907 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21908 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21909 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21910 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21911 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21912 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21913
21914 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21915 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21916 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21917 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21918 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21919 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021920 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021921 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21922
21923 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21924 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21925 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21926 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21927 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21928 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021929 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021930 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21931 occurs.
21932
21933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219348.2.3. HTTP log format
21935----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021936
21937The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21938is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21939the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21940are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21941emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21942generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21943"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21944which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021945frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21946is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021947
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021948The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21949exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010021950if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
21951instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021952
21953 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21954 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21955 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21956
21957And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21958this exact string:
21959
21960 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21961 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21962 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21963 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010021964 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
21965 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021966
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021967Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21968slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21969with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21970
21971 Example :
21972 frontend http-in
21973 mode http
21974 option httplog
21975 log global
21976 default_backend bck
21977
21978 backend static
21979 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21980
21981 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21982 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21983 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021984 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021985
21986 Field Format Extract from the example above
21987 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21988 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021989 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021990 4 frontend_name http-in
21991 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021992 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021993 7 status_code 200
21994 8 bytes_read* 2750
21995 9 captured_request_cookie -
21996 10 captured_response_cookie -
21997 11 termination_state ----
21998 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21999 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22000 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22001 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22002 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022003
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022004Detailed fields description :
22005 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022006 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022007 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22008 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022009 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022010 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022011 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022012
22013 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022014 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22015 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22016 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022017
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022018 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022019 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022020
22021 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22022 and processed the connection.
22023
22024 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22025 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22026 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22027
22028 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22029 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22030 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22031 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22032 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22033 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22034
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022035 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22036 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22037 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022038 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022039 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22040 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022041 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022042 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022043
22044 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22045 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022046 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022047
22048 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22049 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022050 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22051 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022052
22053 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22054 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22055 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22056 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22057 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022058 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22059 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022060
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022061 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022062 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22063 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22064 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22065 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22066 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22067 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022068 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022069
22070 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022071 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22072 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022073
22074 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22075 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022076 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022077 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22078 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22079 overflowing.
22080
22081 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22082 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22083 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22084 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22085 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22086 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22087 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22088 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22089
22090 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22091 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22092 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22093 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22094 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22095 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22096 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22097 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22098
22099 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22100 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22101 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22102 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22103 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22104 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22105 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22106
22107 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022108 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022109 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22110 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22111 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022112 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022113 system.
22114
22115 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22116 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22117 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22118 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22119 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22120 caused by a denial of service attack.
22121
22122 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22123 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22124 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22125 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22126 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22127 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22128 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22129 denial of service attack.
22130
22131 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22132 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22133 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22134 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22135 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22136 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22137 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22138 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22139 processed than on other servers.
22140
22141 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22142 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22143 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22144 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022145 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22147 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22148 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22149 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22150 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22151 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22152 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22153 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22154
22155 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22156 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22157 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22158 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22159 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22160 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022161 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022162 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22163
22164 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22165 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22166 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22167 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22168 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22169 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022170 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022171 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22172 occurs.
22173
22174 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22175 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22176 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22177 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22178 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22179 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22180 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22181 cookies" below for more details.
22182
22183 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22184 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22185 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22186 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22187 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22188 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22189 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22190 and cookies" below for more details.
22191
22192 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22193 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22194 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22195 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22196 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22197 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22198 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22199 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022201
222028.2.4. HTTPS log format
22203----------------------
22204
22205The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22206extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22207information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22208frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22209end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22210matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22211sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22212dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22213"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22214
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022215The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22216exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022217if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22218instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022219
22220 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22221 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22222 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22223 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022224 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022225 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22226 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022227
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022228This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22229appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22230HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022231
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022232 Example :
22233 frontend https-in
22234 mode http
22235 option httpslog
22236 log global
22237 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22238 default_backend bck
22239
22240 backend static
22241 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22242
22243 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22244 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22245 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022246 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22247 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022248
22249 Field Format Extract from the example above
22250 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22251 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22252 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22253 4 frontend_name https-in
22254 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22255 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22256 7 status_code 200
22257 8 bytes_read* 2750
22258 9 captured_request_cookie -
22259 10 captured_response_cookie -
22260 11 termination_state ----
22261 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22262 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22263 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22264 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22265 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022266 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022267 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022268 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22269 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022270
22271Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022272 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22273 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22274 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022275
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022276 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22277 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22278 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022279 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022280 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022281
22282 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22283 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22284 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22285 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22286
22287 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22288 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22289 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22290 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22291
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022292 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22293 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22294 can be shared by multiple requests.
22295
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022296 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22297 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22298 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22299 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22300 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22301
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022302 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22303
22304 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22305
22306
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100223078.2.5. Error log format
22308-----------------------
22309
22310When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22311protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22312unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22313line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22314"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22315will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22316logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22317
22318The default format looks like this :
22319
22320 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22321 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22322 Connection error during SSL handshake
22323
22324 Field Format Extract from the example above
22325 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22326 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22327 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22328 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22329 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22330
22331These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22332failures.
22333
22334By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22335above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22336defined format.
22337
22338An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22339source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22340number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22341internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22342error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22343the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22344certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22345indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22346indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22347ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22348are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22349would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22350regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22351
22352 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022353 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022354 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22355 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22356
22357
223588.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022359------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022360
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022361When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22362ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22363a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22364formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22365looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22366and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022368HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022369Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22370separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22371prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22372
22373Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22374variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022375("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022376
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022377If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022378as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022379less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22380the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22381
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022382Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22383"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22384delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22385preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022386
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022387Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22388'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22389https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22390such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22391
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022392Flags are :
22393 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022394 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022395 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22396 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022397
22398 Example:
22399
22400 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22401 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22402
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022403 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22404
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022405Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22406
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022407 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022408 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022409 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22410 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22411 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022412 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22413 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22414 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022415 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022416 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022417 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022418 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022419 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022420 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22421 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022422 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022423 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022424 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022425 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022426 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022427 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022428 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022429 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22430 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22431 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22432 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22433 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022434 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022435 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022436 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022437 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022438 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022439 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22440 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022441 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22442 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22443 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022444 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022445 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22446 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022447 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022448 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22449 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22450 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022451 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022452 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022453 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22454 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22455 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22456 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022457 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022458 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022459 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022460 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022461 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022462 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022463 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22464 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22465 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022466 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022467 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22468 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022469 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022470 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22471 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022472 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022473 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022474 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022475 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022476
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022477 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022478
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022479
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224808.3. Advanced logging options
22481-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022482
22483Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22484just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22485options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22486for more information about their usage.
22487
22488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22490------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022491
22492It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022493HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022494commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22495monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22496ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22497
22498 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22499 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22500 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22501 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22502
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022503 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22504 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022505
22506 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22507 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22508 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22509
22510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225118.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22512----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022513
22514The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22515what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22516or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022517"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022518just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22519log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22520after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22521is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22522with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22523with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22524
22525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225268.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22527------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022528
22529Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22530for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22531"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22532retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22533raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22534a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22535file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22536you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22537"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22538
22539
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225408.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22541--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022542
22543Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22544multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22545them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22546"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22547logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22548error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22549and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22550too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22551useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22552alternative.
22553
22554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225558.4. Timing events
22556------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022557
22558Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22559reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22560the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22561frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022562mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22563addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22564
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022565Timings events in HTTP mode:
22566
22567 first request 2nd request
22568 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22569 t tr t tr ...
22570 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22571 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22572 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22573 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022574 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022575 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22576
22577Timings events in TCP mode:
22578
22579 TCP session
22580 |<----------------->|
22581 t t
22582 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22583 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22584 |<------ Tt ------->|
22585
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022586 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022587 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022588 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22589 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22590 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022591 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022592 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22593 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22594 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22595 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022596
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022597 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22598 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22599 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022600 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22601 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22602 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22603 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22604 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22605 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022606
22607 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22608 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22609 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22610 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22611 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22612 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22613 request typed by hand during a test.
22614
22615 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22616 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022617 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022618 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22619 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22620 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22621 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022622
22623 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22624 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22625 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22626 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22627 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22628
22629 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22630 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22631 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22632 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22633 connection never established.
22634
22635 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22636 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22637 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22638 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22639 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22640 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22641 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22642 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22643 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22644 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22645 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22646
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022647 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22648 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22649 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22650 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22651 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22652 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22653
22654 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22655
22656 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22657 "Ta" can never be negative.
22658
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022659 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22660 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022661 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22662 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022663 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022664
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022665 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022666
22667 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022668 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
22669 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022670
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022671 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
22672 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
22673 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
22674 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
22675 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
22676 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
22677 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
22678 prefixed with a '+' sign.
22679
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022680These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
22681protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
22682that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022683due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
22684"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
22685that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022686
22687Most common cases :
22688
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022689 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
22690 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
22691 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
22692 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
22693 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022694 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022695 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
22696 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
22697 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
22698 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
22699 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020022700 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022701
22702 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
22703 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
22704 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
22705 of ms on remote networks.
22706
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022707 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
22708 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
22709 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022710
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022711 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
22712 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022713 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022714 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
22715 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
22716 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
22717 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
22718 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
22719 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022720
22721Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
22722
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022723 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022724 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022725 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022726
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022727 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022728 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
22729 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
22730
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022731 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022732 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
22733 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
22734 flags.
22735
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022736 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
22737 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022738 Check the session termination flags, then check the
22739 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
22740 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
22741 the client connection was maintained open.
22742
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022743 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022744 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022745 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022746 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
22747
22748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227498.5. Session state at disconnection
22750-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022751
22752TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
22753"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
227542-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
22755each of which has a special meaning :
22756
22757 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
22758 session to terminate :
22759
22760 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
22761
22762 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
22763 server explicitly refused it.
22764
22765 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
22766 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
22767 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
22768 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022769 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022770
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022771 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022772 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022773
22774 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
22775 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
22776 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
22777 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
22778 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
22779
22780 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
22781 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
22782 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
22783 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
22784 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
22785
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022786 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090022787 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
22788
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022789 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070022790 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
22791 backup connections when going up.
22792
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022793 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020022794
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022795 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
22796 send or receive data.
22797
22798 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
22799 send or receive data.
22800
22801 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
22802 with nothing left in the buffers.
22803
22804 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
22805
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010022806 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022807 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
22808
22809 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
22810 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
22811 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
22812 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
22813 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
22814
22815 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
22816 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
22817
22818 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
22819 server (HTTP only).
22820
22821 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
22822
22823 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
22824 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
22825 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
22826
22827 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
22828 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
22829 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
22830
22831 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
22832
22833 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
22834 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
22835
22836 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
22837 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
22838 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
22839
22840 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
22841 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020022842 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
22843 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022844
22845 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
22846 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
22847 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
22848 another server.
22849
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022850 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022851 server.
22852
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022853 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
22854 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
22855 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
22856 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22857
22858 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
22859 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
22860 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
22861 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
22862
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020022863 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
22864 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
22865 "use-server" rule).
22866
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022867 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22868
22869 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22870 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22871
22872 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22873
22874 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22875 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22876 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22877
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022878 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22879 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022880 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022881 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22882 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22883
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022884 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22885
22886 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22887 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22888
22889 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22890
22891 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22892
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022893The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22894was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022895helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22896starvation, attacks, etc...
22897
22898The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22899alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22900easier finding and understanding.
22901
22902 Flags Reason
22903
22904 -- Normal termination.
22905
22906 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022907 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22908 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022909 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22910
22911 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22912 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022913 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22914 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022915 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22916 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022917
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022918 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22919 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022920 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022921
22922 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22923 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22924 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22925
22926 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22927 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22928 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22929 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22930 the server takes too long to respond.
22931
22932 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22933 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22934 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22935 long a time to respond.
22936
22937 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22938 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22939 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022940 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022941 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22942 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022943
22944 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22945 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22946 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22947 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22948 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022949 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022950 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22951 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22952 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22953 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22954 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22955 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22956 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22957 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022958 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022959 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22960 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22961 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022962
22963 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22964 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022965 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22966 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22967 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22968 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022969
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022970 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022971 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22972
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022973 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022974 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22975 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022976 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022977 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22978 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22979
22980 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22981 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22982 503 or 504 here.
22983
22984 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022985 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022986 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22987 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22988 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22989
22990 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22991 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022992 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022993 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022994 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022995
22996 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22997 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22998 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22999 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23000 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23001 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023002 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023003
23004 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23005 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23006 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23007 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23008 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23009 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23010 solution is to fix the application.
23011
23012 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23013 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23014 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23015 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23016 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23017 external attacks.
23018
23019 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023020 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023021 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023022 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23023 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23024
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023025 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23026 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23027 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023028 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023029 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023030
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023031 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23032 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23033 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23034 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023035 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23036 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23037 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23038 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023039 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23040 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23041 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23042 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023043
23044 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23045 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23046 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023047 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23048 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23049 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23050 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023051
23052 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23053 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23054 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23055 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23056
23057 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23058 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23059 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23060 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23061
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023062The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023063persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023064important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23065re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23066
23067 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23068
23069 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23070 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23071 set on a GET request.
23072
23073 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23074 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023075 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023076 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23077
23078 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23079 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23080 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23081
23082 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23083 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23084 already got a cookie.
23085
23086 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23087 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23088 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23089 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23090 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23091
23092 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23093 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23094 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23095
23096 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23097 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23098 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23099
23100 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23101 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23102
23103 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23104 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23105 then advertised in the response.
23106
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231088.6. Non-printable characters
23109-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023110
23111In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23112consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23113converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23114prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23115being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23116escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23117is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23118'}' when logging headers.
23119
23120Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23121issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23122containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23123
23124Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23125the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23126performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23127
23128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231298.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23130---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023131
23132Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23133achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023134section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023135cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23136the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23137the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023138locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023139not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23140user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23141a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23142wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23143
23144 Examples :
23145 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23146 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23147
23148 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23149 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23150
23151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200231528.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23153---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023154
23155Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23156proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23157the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23158server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23159
23160Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23161response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023162section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023163
23164It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023165time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23166appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023167are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23168and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23169follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23170request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23171in the logs.
23172
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023173As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23174frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23175an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23176
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023177 Example :
23178 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23179 listen proxy-out
23180 mode http
23181 option httplog
23182 option logasap
23183 log global
23184 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23185
23186 # log the name of the virtual server
23187 capture request header Host len 20
23188
23189 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23190 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23191
23192 # log the beginning of the referrer
23193 capture request header Referer len 20
23194
23195 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23196 capture response header Server len 20
23197
23198 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23199 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023201 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023202 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23203
23204 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23205 capture response header Via len 20
23206
23207 # log the URL location during a redirection
23208 capture response header Location len 20
23209
23210 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23211 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23212 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23213 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23214 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23215
23216 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23217 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23218 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23219 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023220 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023221
23222 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23223 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23224 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23225 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23226 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023227 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023228
23229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232308.9. Examples of logs
23231---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023232
23233These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23234them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23235reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23236
23237 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23238 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23239 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23240
23241 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23242 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23243
23244 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23245 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23246 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23247
23248 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23249 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23250
23251 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23252 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23253 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23254
23255 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023256 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023257 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23258 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23259
23260 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23261 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23262 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23263
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023264 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23265 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23266 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23267 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023268 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023269 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023270
23271 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023272 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023273
23274 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23275 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23276 Nothing was sent to any server.
23277
23278 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23279 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23280
23281 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23282 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023283 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023284 send a 408 return code to the client.
23285
23286 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23287 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23288
23289 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23290 5 seconds ("c----").
23291
23292 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23293 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023294 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023295
23296 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023297 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023298 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23299 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23300 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23301 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23302 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023303
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023304
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200233059. Supported filters
23306--------------------
23307
23308Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23309accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23310unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23311
23312See also : "filter"
23313
233149.1. Trace
23315----------
23316
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023317filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023318
23319 Arguments:
23320 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23321 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23322
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023323 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023324
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023325 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023326 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23327 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23328 amount of the parsed data.
23329
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023330 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023331
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023332This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23333callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23334information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23335filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23336
23337Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23338tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23339a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23340
23341
233429.2. HTTP compression
23343---------------------
23344
23345filter compression
23346
23347The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23348keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023349when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23350fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23351done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23352explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23353filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23354listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23355order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023356
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023357See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23358 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023359
23360
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200233619.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23362--------------------------------------------
23363
23364filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23365
23366 Arguments :
23367
23368 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23369 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23370 parsed.
23371
23372 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23373 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23374 part must be placed in its own scope.
23375
23376The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23377external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023378streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023379exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23380also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23381
23382SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23383the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23384
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023385For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023386"doc/SPOE.txt".
23387
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100233889.4. Cache
23389----------
23390
23391filter cache <name>
23392
23393 Arguments :
23394
23395 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23396
23397The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23398"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023399cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023400other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23401case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23402is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23403filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023404listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23405order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023406
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023407See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23408 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23409
23410
234119.5. Fcgi-app
23412-------------
23413
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023414filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023415
23416 Arguments :
23417
23418 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23419
23420The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23421request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23422reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23423used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23424implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23425used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23426fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23427used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23428order.
23429
23430See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23431 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23432
23433
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100234349.6. OpenTracing
23435----------------
23436
23437The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23438HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23439of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23440Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23441
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023442This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023443
23444The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23445HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23446participates in the work of HAProxy.
23447
23448filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23449
23450 Arguments :
23451
23452 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23453 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23454 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23455 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23456 OpenTracing filters.
23457
23458 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23459 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23460 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23461 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23462 filter must have its own scope defined.
23463
23464More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023465of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023466
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200234679.7. Bandwidth limitation
23468--------------------------
23469
23470filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23471filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23472filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23473filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23474
23475 Arguments :
23476
23477 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23478 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23479
23480 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23481 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23482 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23483 expressed in bytes.
23484
23485 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23486 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23487 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23488 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23489
23490 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23491 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23492 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23493
23494 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023495 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023496 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23497 is expressed in milliseconds.
23498
23499 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23500 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23501 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23502 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23503 expressed in bytes.
23504
23505Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
23506speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
23507bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
23508used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
23509sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
23510other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
23511connections for a given client.
23512
23513The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
23514filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
23515definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
23516the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
23517compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
23518the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
23519for the cache filter.
23520
23521There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
23522default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050023523to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023524the table.
23525
23526In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
23527limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
23528forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
23529the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
23530used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
23531cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
23532level.
23533
23534The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
23535connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
23536of the same connection may have different limits.
23537
23538For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
23539defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
23540bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
23541only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
23542when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
23543
23544For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
23545incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
23546corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23547stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23548used to limit outgoing data.
23549
23550Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
23551limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
23552to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
23553carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
23554it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
23555limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
23556experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
23557a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
23558start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
23559some experimentations.
23560
23561 Example:
23562 frontend http
23563 bind *:80
23564 mode http
23565
23566 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
23567 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
23568 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
23569
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023570 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023571 # independently of all other streams.
23572 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
23573
23574 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
23575 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
23576 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
23577 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
23578 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
23579 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
23580 ...
23581
23582 backend limit-by-src
23583 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
23584 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
23585
23586See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
23587 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
23588 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
23589 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023590
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002359110. FastCGI applications
23592-------------------------
23593
23594HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
23595feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
23596the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
23597FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
23598servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
23599FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
23600backend.
23601
23602HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23603application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23604connection.
23605
2360610.1. Setup
23607-----------
23608
2360910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23610--------------------------
23611
23612fcgi-app <name>
23613 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23614 document root must be defined.
23615
23616acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23617 Declare or complete an access list.
23618
23619 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23620 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23621 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23622 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23623 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23624
23625docroot <path>
23626 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23627 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23628 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23629
23630index <script-name>
23631 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23632 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23633 is an optional setting.
23634
23635 Example :
23636 index index.php
23637
23638log-stderr global
23639log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023640 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023641 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23642
23643 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23644 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23645
23646pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23647 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
23648 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
23649 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23650
23651 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
23652 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
23653 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
23654 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
23655
23656 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
23657 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
23658
23659path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023660 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023661 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
23662 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
23663 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
23664 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
23665 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
23666 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
23667 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023668
23669 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023670 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023671 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
23672 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
23673 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
23674 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023675
23676 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023677 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
23678 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023679
23680option get-values
23681no option get-values
23682 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
23683
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023684 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023685 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
23686
23687 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
23688 application will accept.
23689
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020023690 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
23691 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023692
23693 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050023694 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023695 option is disabled.
23696
23697 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
23698 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
23699 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
23700 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
23701 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
23702 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
23703
23704option keep-conn
23705no option keep-conn
23706 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
23707 sending a response.
23708
23709 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
23710 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
23711
23712option max-reqs <reqs>
23713 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
23714 accept.
23715
23716 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
23717 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
23718 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
23719 to 1.
23720
23721option mpxs-conns
23722no option mpxs-conns
23723 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
23724
23725 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
23726 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
23727
23728set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23729 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
23730 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
23731 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
23732 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23733
23734 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
23735 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
23736 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
23737
23738 Example :
23739 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
23740 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
23741
23742 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
23743
23744
2374510.1.2. Proxy section
23746---------------------
23747
23748use-fcgi-app <name>
23749 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
23750
23751 Arguments :
23752 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
23753
23754 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
23755 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
23756 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
23757 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
23758 application may be defined at a time per backend.
23759
23760 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
23761 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
23762 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
23763 application are evaluated.
23764
23765
2376610.1.3. Example
23767---------------
23768
23769 frontend front-http
23770 mode http
23771 bind *:80
23772 bind *:
23773
23774 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
23775 default_backend back-static
23776
23777 backend back-static
23778 mode http
23779 server www A.B.C.D:80
23780
23781 backend back-dynamic
23782 mode http
23783 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
23784 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
23785
23786 fcgi-app php-fpm
23787 log-stderr global
23788 option keep-conn
23789
23790 docroot /var/www/my-app
23791 index index.php
23792 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
23793
23794
2379510.2. Default parameters
23796------------------------
23797
23798A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
23799the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050023800script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023801applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
23802
23803 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23804 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
23805 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
23806 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
23807 | | |
23808 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23809 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
23810 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
23811 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
23812 | | application. |
23813 | | |
23814 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23815 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
23816 | | the request. It may not be set. |
23817 | | |
23818 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23819 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
23820 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
23821 | | the application's configuration. |
23822 | | |
23823 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23824 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
23825 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
23826 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
23827 | | |
23828 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23829 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
23830 | | following the part that identifies the script |
23831 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
23832 | | be defined. |
23833 | | |
23834 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23835 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
23836 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
23837 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
23838 | | is not set too. |
23839 | | |
23840 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23841 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
23842 | | set. |
23843 | | |
23844 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23845 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
23846 | | the request. |
23847 | | |
23848 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23849 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
23850 | | client as part of user authentication. |
23851 | | |
23852 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23853 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
23854 | | script to process the request. |
23855 | | |
23856 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23857 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
23858 | | |
23859 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23860 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
23861 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
23862 | | |
23863 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23864 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
23865 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
23866 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
23867 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
23868 | | |
23869 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23870 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
23871 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
23872 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
23873 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
23874 | | side. |
23875 | | |
23876 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23877 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
23878 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
23879 | | connected to. |
23880 | | |
23881 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23882 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
23883 | | |
23884 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020023885 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
23886 | | current HAProxy version. |
23887 | | |
23888 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023889 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
23890 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
23891 | | |
23892 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
23893
23894
2389510.3. Limitations
23896------------------
23897
23898The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
23899way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
23900during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
23901establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
23902application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
23903or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
23904message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
23905these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
23906and HTTP servers under the same backend.
23907
23908Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
23909request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
23910requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
23911
23912About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
23913into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
23914fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
23915"http-request" ones.
23916
23917Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
23918FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
23919processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
23920must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
23921here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010023922
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020023923
2392411. Address formats
23925-------------------
23926
23927Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
23928address.
23929
23930This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
23931The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
23932of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
23933equivalent is '::'.
23934
23935Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
23936is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
23937
23938This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
23939family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
23940
23941Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
23942configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
23943use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
23944'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
23945
23946Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
23947socket type and the transport method.
23948
23949
2395011.1 Address family prefixes
23951----------------------------
23952
23953'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
23954
23955'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
23956 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
23957 listening.
23958
23959'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
23960 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
23961 on the statement using this address, a port or
23962 a port range may or must be specified.
23963
23964'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23965 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
23966 using this address, a port or a port range
23967 may or must be specified.
23968
23969'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23970 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
23971 using this address, a port or a port range
23972 may or must be specified.
23973
23974'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
23975 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
23976 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
23977 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
23978 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
23979 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
23980
23981'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
23982 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
23983 start by slash '/'.
23984
23985
2398611.2 Socket type prefixes
23987-------------------------
23988
23989Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
23990type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
23991this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
23992This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
23993but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
23994
23995Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
23996instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
23997
23998If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23999they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24000report this to the maintainers.
24001
24002'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24003 to "stream"
24004
24005'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24006 to "datagram".
24007
24008
2400911.3 Protocol prefixes
24010----------------------
24011
24012'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24013 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24014 socket type and transport method is forced to
24015 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24016 this address, a port or a port range can or
24017 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24018 of 'stream+ip@'.
24019
24020'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24021 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24022 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24023 statement using this address, a port or port
24024 range can or must be specified.
24025 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24026
24027'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24028 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24029 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24030 statement using this address, a port or port
24031 range can or must be specified.
24032 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24033
24034'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24035 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24036 socket type and transport method is forced to
24037 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24038 this address, a port or a port range can or
24039 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24040 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24041
24042'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24043 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24044 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24045 the statement using this address, a port or
24046 port range can or must be specified.
24047 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24048
24049'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24050 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24051 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24052 the statement using this address, a port or
24053 port range can or must be specified.
24054 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24055
24056'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24057 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24058 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24059
24060'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24061 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24062 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24063
24064In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24065QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24066
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024067/*
24068 * Local variables:
24069 * fill-column: 79
24070 * End:
24071 */